]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/ada-lang.c
gdb: Convert language la_search_name_hash field to a method
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1992-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20
21 #include "defs.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "gdb_regex.h"
24 #include "frame.h"
25 #include "symtab.h"
26 #include "gdbtypes.h"
27 #include "gdbcmd.h"
28 #include "expression.h"
29 #include "parser-defs.h"
30 #include "language.h"
31 #include "varobj.h"
32 #include "inferior.h"
33 #include "symfile.h"
34 #include "objfiles.h"
35 #include "breakpoint.h"
36 #include "gdbcore.h"
37 #include "hashtab.h"
38 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
39 #include "ada-lang.h"
40 #include "completer.h"
41 #include "ui-out.h"
42 #include "block.h"
43 #include "infcall.h"
44 #include "annotate.h"
45 #include "valprint.h"
46 #include "source.h"
47 #include "observable.h"
48 #include "stack.h"
49 #include "typeprint.h"
50 #include "namespace.h"
51 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
52
53 #include "value.h"
54 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
55 #include "arch-utils.h"
56 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
57 #include "gdbsupport/function-view.h"
58 #include "gdbsupport/byte-vector.h"
59 #include <algorithm>
60
61 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
62 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
63 Copied from valarith.c. */
64
65 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
66 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
67 #endif
68
69 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
70
71 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
72
73 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
74
75 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
76
77 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
78
79 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
80
81 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
82
83 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
84
85 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
86
87 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
88
89 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
90
91 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
92
93 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
94
95 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
96
97 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
98
99 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
100
101 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *);
102
103 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
104 const struct block *,
105 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
106 domain_enum, struct objfile *);
107
108 static void ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *, const struct block *,
109 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
110 domain_enum, int, int *);
111
112 static int is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol *, int);
113
114 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
115 const struct block *);
116
117 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
118
119 static struct block_symbol *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
120
121 static struct value *resolve_subexp (expression_up *, int *, int,
122 struct type *, int,
123 innermost_block_tracker *);
124
125 static void replace_operator_with_call (expression_up *, int, int, int,
126 struct symbol *, const struct block *);
127
128 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
129
130 static const char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
131
132 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
133
134 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
135
136 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
137
138 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
139
140 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
141
142 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, const char *,
143 int, int);
144
145 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
146
147 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *,
148 const char *);
149
150 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
151
152 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
153 const gdb_byte *,
154 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
155
156 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
157
158 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *);
159
160 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
161 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
162
163 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
164
165 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
166
167 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
168
169 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
170
171 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
172
173 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
174
175 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
176
177 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
178 struct value **);
179
180 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
181 struct type *);
182
183 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
184
185 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
186
187 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
188
189 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int);
190
191 static bool wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn);
192
193 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
194
195 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
196
197 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
198
199 static struct value *val_atr (struct type *, LONGEST);
200
201 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
202
203 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
204 domain_enum);
205
206 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (const char *, struct value *, int,
207 struct type *);
208
209 static int find_struct_field (const char *, struct type *, int,
210 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
211
212 static int ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol *, int,
213 struct value **, int, const char *,
214 struct type *, int);
215
216 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
217
218 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
219 struct type *);
220
221 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
222 struct expression *,
223 int *, enum noside);
224
225 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
226 struct expression *,
227 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
228 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
229
230 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
231 struct expression *,
232 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
233 LONGEST, LONGEST);
234
235
236 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
237 struct expression *,
238 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
239
240
241 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
242
243
244 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
245 int *, enum noside);
246
247 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
248 int *);
249
250 static struct type *ada_find_any_type (const char *name);
251
252 static symbol_name_matcher_ftype *ada_get_symbol_name_matcher
253 (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name);
254
255 \f
256
257 /* The result of a symbol lookup to be stored in our symbol cache. */
258
259 struct cache_entry
260 {
261 /* The name used to perform the lookup. */
262 const char *name;
263 /* The namespace used during the lookup. */
264 domain_enum domain;
265 /* The symbol returned by the lookup, or NULL if no matching symbol
266 was found. */
267 struct symbol *sym;
268 /* The block where the symbol was found, or NULL if no matching
269 symbol was found. */
270 const struct block *block;
271 /* A pointer to the next entry with the same hash. */
272 struct cache_entry *next;
273 };
274
275 /* The Ada symbol cache, used to store the result of Ada-mode symbol
276 lookups in the course of executing the user's commands.
277
278 The cache is implemented using a simple, fixed-sized hash.
279 The size is fixed on the grounds that there are not likely to be
280 all that many symbols looked up during any given session, regardless
281 of the size of the symbol table. If we decide to go to a resizable
282 table, let's just use the stuff from libiberty instead. */
283
284 #define HASH_SIZE 1009
285
286 struct ada_symbol_cache
287 {
288 /* An obstack used to store the entries in our cache. */
289 struct obstack cache_space;
290
291 /* The root of the hash table used to implement our symbol cache. */
292 struct cache_entry *root[HASH_SIZE];
293 };
294
295 static void ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache);
296
297 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
298 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
299
300 static const char ada_completer_word_break_characters[] =
301 #ifdef VMS
302 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
303 #else
304 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
305 #endif
306
307 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
308 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
309 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
310
311 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
312 static int warning_limit = 2;
313
314 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
315 expression evaluation. */
316 static int warnings_issued = 0;
317
318 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
319 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
320 };
321
322 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
323 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
324 };
325
326 /* Maintenance-related settings for this module. */
327
328 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_set_ada_cmdlist;
329 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_show_ada_cmdlist;
330
331 /* The "maintenance ada set/show ignore-descriptive-type" value. */
332
333 static bool ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p = false;
334
335 /* Inferior-specific data. */
336
337 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */
338
339 struct ada_inferior_data
340 {
341 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding
342 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly
343 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this
344 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */
345 struct type *tsd_type = nullptr;
346
347 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine
348 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given
349 inferior. */
350 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info = nullptr;
351 };
352
353 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */
354 static const struct inferior_key<ada_inferior_data> ada_inferior_data;
355
356 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF).
357
358 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated
359 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not
360 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all
361 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns
362 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */
363
364 static struct ada_inferior_data *
365 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
366 {
367 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
368
369 data = ada_inferior_data.get (inf);
370 if (data == NULL)
371 data = ada_inferior_data.emplace (inf);
372
373 return data;
374 }
375
376 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data
377 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */
378
379 static void
380 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf)
381 {
382 ada_inferior_data.clear (inf);
383 }
384
385
386 /* program-space-specific data. */
387
388 /* This module's per-program-space data. */
389 struct ada_pspace_data
390 {
391 ~ada_pspace_data ()
392 {
393 if (sym_cache != NULL)
394 ada_free_symbol_cache (sym_cache);
395 }
396
397 /* The Ada symbol cache. */
398 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache = nullptr;
399 };
400
401 /* Key to our per-program-space data. */
402 static const struct program_space_key<ada_pspace_data> ada_pspace_data_handle;
403
404 /* Return this module's data for the given program space (PSPACE).
405 If not is found, add a zero'ed one now.
406
407 This function always returns a valid object. */
408
409 static struct ada_pspace_data *
410 get_ada_pspace_data (struct program_space *pspace)
411 {
412 struct ada_pspace_data *data;
413
414 data = ada_pspace_data_handle.get (pspace);
415 if (data == NULL)
416 data = ada_pspace_data_handle.emplace (pspace);
417
418 return data;
419 }
420
421 /* Utilities */
422
423 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after
424 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE.
425
426 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer.
427 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be
428 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because
429 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction.
430 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many
431 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally
432 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain
433 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding).
434
435 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information
436 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For
437 instance, consider the following example with stabs:
438
439 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...]
440 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0
441
442 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type
443 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time,
444 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef.
445
446 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is
447 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these
448 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */
449
450 static struct type *
451 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type)
452 {
453 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
454 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
455 return type;
456 }
457
458 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
459 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
460 its unqualified name. */
461
462 static const char *
463 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
464 {
465 const char *result;
466
467 /* If the decoded name starts with '<', it means that the encoded
468 name does not follow standard naming conventions, and thus that
469 it is not your typical Ada symbol name. Trying to unqualify it
470 is therefore pointless and possibly erroneous. */
471 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
472 return decoded_name;
473
474 result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
475 if (result != NULL)
476 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
477 else
478 result = decoded_name;
479
480 return result;
481 }
482
483 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'. */
484
485 static std::string
486 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
487 {
488 return string_printf ("<%s>", str);
489 }
490
491 static const char *
492 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
493 {
494 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
495 }
496
497 /* la_watch_location_expression for Ada. */
498
499 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
500 ada_watch_location_expression (struct type *type, CORE_ADDR addr)
501 {
502 type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (type)));
503 std::string name = type_to_string (type);
504 return gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
505 (xstrprintf ("{%s} %s", name.c_str (), core_addr_to_string (addr)));
506 }
507
508 /* Assuming V points to an array of S objects, make sure that it contains at
509 least M objects, updating V and S as necessary. */
510
511 #define GROW_VECT(v, s, m) \
512 if ((s) < (m)) (v) = (char *) grow_vect (v, &(s), m, sizeof *(v));
513
514 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
515 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
516 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
517
518 static void *
519 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
520 {
521 if (*size < min_size)
522 {
523 *size *= 2;
524 if (*size < min_size)
525 *size = min_size;
526 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
527 }
528 return vect;
529 }
530
531 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
532 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
533
534 static int
535 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
536 {
537 int len = strlen (target);
538
539 return
540 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
541 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
542 || (startswith (field_name + len, "___")
543 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
544 "___XVN") != 0)));
545 }
546
547
548 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
549 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
550 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
551 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
552 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
553 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
554 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
555
556 int
557 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
558 int maybe_missing)
559 {
560 int fieldno;
561 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
562
563 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < struct_type->num_fields (); fieldno++)
564 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
565 return fieldno;
566
567 if (!maybe_missing)
568 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
569 field_name, struct_type->name ());
570
571 return -1;
572 }
573
574 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
575
576 int
577 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
578 {
579 if (name == NULL)
580 return 0;
581 else
582 {
583 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
584
585 if (p == NULL)
586 return strlen (name);
587 else
588 return p - name;
589 }
590 }
591
592 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
593 Return zero if STR is null. */
594
595 static int
596 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
597 {
598 int len1, len2;
599
600 if (str == NULL)
601 return 0;
602 len1 = strlen (str);
603 len2 = strlen (suffix);
604 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
605 }
606
607 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
608 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
609
610 static struct value *
611 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
612 {
613 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
614 if (value_type (val) == type)
615 return val;
616 else
617 {
618 struct value *result;
619
620 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
621 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
622 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
623
624 if (value_lazy (val)
625 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
626 result = allocate_value_lazy (type);
627 else
628 {
629 result = allocate_value (type);
630 value_contents_copy_raw (result, 0, val, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
631 }
632 set_value_component_location (result, val);
633 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
634 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
635 if (VALUE_LVAL (result) == lval_memory)
636 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
637 return result;
638 }
639 }
640
641 static const gdb_byte *
642 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
643 {
644 if (valaddr == NULL)
645 return NULL;
646 else
647 return valaddr + offset;
648 }
649
650 static CORE_ADDR
651 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
652 {
653 if (address == 0)
654 return 0;
655 else
656 return address + offset;
657 }
658
659 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
660 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
661 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
662 expression. */
663
664 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
665 provided by "complaint". */
666 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2);
667
668 static void
669 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
670 {
671 va_list args;
672
673 va_start (args, format);
674 warnings_issued += 1;
675 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
676 vwarning (format, args);
677
678 va_end (args);
679 }
680
681 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
682 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
683 GDB. */
684
685 void
686 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (const struct type *type)
687 {
688 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
689 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
690 }
691
692 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
693 static LONGEST
694 max_of_size (int size)
695 {
696 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
697
698 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
699 }
700
701 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
702 static LONGEST
703 min_of_size (int size)
704 {
705 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
706 }
707
708 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
709 static ULONGEST
710 umax_of_size (int size)
711 {
712 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
713
714 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
715 }
716
717 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
718 static LONGEST
719 max_of_type (struct type *t)
720 {
721 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
722 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
723 else
724 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
725 }
726
727 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
728 static LONGEST
729 min_of_type (struct type *t)
730 {
731 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
732 return 0;
733 else
734 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
735 }
736
737 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
738 LONGEST
739 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
740 {
741 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, {}, 0);
742 switch (type->code ())
743 {
744 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
745 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
746 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
747 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, type->num_fields () - 1);
748 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
749 return 1;
750 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
751 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
752 return max_of_type (type);
753 default:
754 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
755 }
756 }
757
758 /* The smallest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
759 LONGEST
760 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
761 {
762 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, {}, 0);
763 switch (type->code ())
764 {
765 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
766 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
767 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
768 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, 0);
769 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
770 return 0;
771 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
772 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
773 return min_of_type (type);
774 default:
775 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
776 }
777 }
778
779 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
780 non-range scalar type. */
781
782 static struct type *
783 get_base_type (struct type *type)
784 {
785 while (type != NULL && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
786 {
787 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
788 return type;
789 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
790 }
791 return type;
792 }
793
794 /* Return a decoded version of the given VALUE. This means returning
795 a value whose type is obtained by applying all the GNAT-specific
796 encodings, making the resulting type a static but standard description
797 of the initial type. */
798
799 struct value *
800 ada_get_decoded_value (struct value *value)
801 {
802 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (value));
803
804 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)
805 || (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)
806 && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR))
807 {
808 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) /* array access type. */
809 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (value);
810 else
811 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (value);
812 }
813 else
814 value = ada_to_fixed_value (value);
815
816 return value;
817 }
818
819 /* Same as ada_get_decoded_value, but with the given TYPE.
820 Because there is no associated actual value for this type,
821 the resulting type might be a best-effort approximation in
822 the case of dynamic types. */
823
824 struct type *
825 ada_get_decoded_type (struct type *type)
826 {
827 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
828 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
829 type = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (type);
830 return type;
831 }
832
833 \f
834
835 /* Language Selection */
836
837 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
838 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */
839
840 static enum language
841 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang)
842 {
843 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", NULL, NULL).minsym != NULL)
844 return language_ada;
845
846 return lang;
847 }
848
849 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
850 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
851 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
852
853 char *
854 ada_main_name (void)
855 {
856 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
857 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> main_program_name;
858
859 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
860 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
861 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
862 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
863 in Ada. */
864 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
865
866 if (msym.minsym != NULL)
867 {
868 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
869 int err_code;
870
871 main_program_name_addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
872 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
873 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
874
875 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
876 1024, &err_code);
877
878 if (err_code != 0)
879 return NULL;
880 return main_program_name.get ();
881 }
882
883 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
884 return NULL;
885 }
886 \f
887 /* Symbols */
888
889 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
890 of NULLs. */
891
892 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
893 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
894 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
895 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
896 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
897 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
898 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
899 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
900 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
901 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
902 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
903 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
904 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
905 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
906 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
907 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
908 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
909 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
910 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
911 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
912 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
913 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
914 {NULL, NULL}
915 };
916
917 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions. The
918 result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. If
919 THROW_ERRORS, throw an error if invalid operator name is found.
920 Otherwise, return NULL in that case. */
921
922 static char *
923 ada_encode_1 (const char *decoded, bool throw_errors)
924 {
925 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
926 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
927 const char *p;
928 int k;
929
930 if (decoded == NULL)
931 return NULL;
932
933 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
934 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
935
936 k = 0;
937 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
938 {
939 if (*p == '.')
940 {
941 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
942 k += 2;
943 }
944 else if (*p == '"')
945 {
946 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
947
948 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
949 mapping->encoded != NULL
950 && !startswith (p, mapping->decoded); mapping += 1)
951 ;
952 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
953 {
954 if (throw_errors)
955 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
956 else
957 return NULL;
958 }
959 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
960 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
961 break;
962 }
963 else
964 {
965 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
966 k += 1;
967 }
968 }
969
970 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
971 return encoding_buffer;
972 }
973
974 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
975 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
976
977 char *
978 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
979 {
980 return ada_encode_1 (decoded, true);
981 }
982
983 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
984 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
985 to next call. */
986
987 static char *
988 ada_fold_name (gdb::string_view name)
989 {
990 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
991 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
992
993 int len = name.size ();
994 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
995
996 if (name[0] == '\'')
997 {
998 strncpy (fold_buffer, name.data () + 1, len - 2);
999 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
1000 }
1001 else
1002 {
1003 int i;
1004
1005 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
1006 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
1007 }
1008
1009 return fold_buffer;
1010 }
1011
1012 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
1013
1014 static int
1015 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
1016 {
1017 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
1018 }
1019
1020 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length.
1021 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but
1022 without either of these suffixes:
1023 . .{DIGIT}+
1024 . ${DIGIT}+
1025 . ___{DIGIT}+
1026 . __{DIGIT}+.
1027
1028 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
1029 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
1030 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
1031
1032 static void
1033 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
1034 {
1035 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
1036 {
1037 int i = *len - 2;
1038
1039 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1040 i--;
1041 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
1042 *len = i;
1043 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
1044 *len = i;
1045 else if (i >= 2 && startswith (encoded + i - 2, "___"))
1046 *len = i - 2;
1047 else if (i >= 1 && startswith (encoded + i - 1, "__"))
1048 *len = i - 1;
1049 }
1050 }
1051
1052 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
1053 subprograms. */
1054
1055 static void
1056 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1057 {
1058 /* Remove trailing N. */
1059
1060 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
1061 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
1062 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
1063 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
1064 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
1065 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
1066 entity is internal. */
1067
1068 if (*len > 1
1069 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
1070 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
1071 *len = *len - 1;
1072 }
1073
1074 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
1075 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
1076 replaced by ENCODED. */
1077
1078 std::string
1079 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
1080 {
1081 int i, j;
1082 int len0;
1083 const char *p;
1084 int at_start_name;
1085 std::string decoded;
1086
1087 /* With function descriptors on PPC64, the value of a symbol named
1088 ".FN", if it exists, is the entry point of the function "FN". */
1089 if (encoded[0] == '.')
1090 encoded += 1;
1091
1092 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
1093 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
1094 if we see this prefix. */
1095 if (startswith (encoded, "_ada_"))
1096 encoded += 5;
1097
1098 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
1099 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
1100 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
1101 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
1102 goto Suppress;
1103
1104 len0 = strlen (encoded);
1105
1106 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
1107 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
1108
1109 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
1110 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
1111 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
1112 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
1113 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
1114 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
1115 {
1116 if (p[3] == 'X')
1117 len0 = p - encoded;
1118 else
1119 goto Suppress;
1120 }
1121
1122 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
1123 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
1124 appear in the decoded name. */
1125
1126 if (len0 > 3 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB"))
1127 len0 -= 3;
1128
1129 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
1130 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
1131 bodies. */
1132
1133 if (len0 > 2 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB"))
1134 len0 -= 2;
1135
1136 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
1137 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
1138
1139 if (len0 > 1 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 1, "B"))
1140 len0 -= 1;
1141
1142 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
1143
1144 decoded.resize (2 * len0 + 1, 'X');
1145
1146 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
1147
1148 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1149 {
1150 i = len0 - 2;
1151 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1152 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1153 i -= 1;
1154 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1155 len0 = i - 1;
1156 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1157 len0 = i;
1158 }
1159
1160 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1161 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1162
1163 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1164 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1165
1166 at_start_name = 1;
1167 while (i < len0)
1168 {
1169 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1170 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1171 {
1172 int k;
1173
1174 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1175 {
1176 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1177 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1178 op_len - 1) == 0)
1179 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1180 {
1181 strcpy (&decoded.front() + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1182 at_start_name = 0;
1183 i += op_len;
1184 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1185 break;
1186 }
1187 }
1188 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1189 continue;
1190 }
1191 at_start_name = 0;
1192
1193 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1194 into "." (just below). */
1195
1196 if (i < len0 - 4 && startswith (encoded + i, "TK__"))
1197 i += 2;
1198
1199 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1200 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1201 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1202
1203 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1204 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1205 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1206 {
1207 int k = i + 5;
1208
1209 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1210 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1211
1212 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1213 is indeed followed by "__". */
1214 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1215 i = k;
1216 }
1217
1218 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1219
1220 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1221 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1222 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1223 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1224 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1225 by a 'B'.
1226
1227 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1228 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1229 internally generated. */
1230
1231 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1232 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1233 {
1234 int k = i + 3;
1235
1236 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1237 k++;
1238
1239 if (k < len0
1240 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1241 {
1242 k++;
1243 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1244 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1245 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1246 if (k == len0
1247 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1248 i = k;
1249 }
1250 }
1251
1252 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1253 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1254
1255 if (i < len0 + 3
1256 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1257 {
1258 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1259 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1260 digits or lowercase characters. */
1261 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1262
1263 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1264 ptr--;
1265 if (ptr < encoded
1266 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1267 i++;
1268 }
1269
1270 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1271 {
1272 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1273 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1274 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1275 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1276 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1277 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1278 package names. */
1279 do
1280 i += 1;
1281 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1282 if (i < len0)
1283 goto Suppress;
1284 }
1285 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1286 {
1287 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1288 decoded[j] = '.';
1289 at_start_name = 1;
1290 i += 2;
1291 j += 1;
1292 }
1293 else
1294 {
1295 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1296 over. */
1297 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1298 i += 1;
1299 j += 1;
1300 }
1301 }
1302 decoded.resize (j);
1303
1304 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1305 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1306
1307 for (i = 0; i < decoded.length(); ++i)
1308 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1309 goto Suppress;
1310
1311 return decoded;
1312
1313 Suppress:
1314 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1315 decoded = encoded;
1316 else
1317 decoded = '<' + std::string(encoded) + '>';
1318 return decoded;
1319
1320 }
1321
1322 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1323 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1324 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1325 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1326 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1327 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1328
1329 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1330 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1331 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1332 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1333 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1334 GSYMBOL).
1335 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1336 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1337 when a decoded name is cached in it. */
1338
1339 const char *
1340 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *arg)
1341 {
1342 struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol = (struct general_symbol_info *) arg;
1343 const char **resultp =
1344 &gsymbol->language_specific.demangled_name;
1345
1346 if (!gsymbol->ada_mangled)
1347 {
1348 std::string decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->linkage_name ());
1349 struct obstack *obstack = gsymbol->language_specific.obstack;
1350
1351 gsymbol->ada_mangled = 1;
1352
1353 if (obstack != NULL)
1354 *resultp = obstack_strdup (obstack, decoded.c_str ());
1355 else
1356 {
1357 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in
1358 which case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only
1359 decode when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1360 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1361
1362 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1363 decoded.c_str (), INSERT);
1364
1365 if (*slot == NULL)
1366 *slot = xstrdup (decoded.c_str ());
1367 *resultp = *slot;
1368 }
1369 }
1370
1371 return *resultp;
1372 }
1373
1374 static char *
1375 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1376 {
1377 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded).c_str ());
1378 }
1379
1380 /* Implement la_sniff_from_mangled_name for Ada. */
1381
1382 static int
1383 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name (const char *mangled, char **out)
1384 {
1385 std::string demangled = ada_decode (mangled);
1386
1387 *out = NULL;
1388
1389 if (demangled != mangled && demangled[0] != '<')
1390 {
1391 /* Set the gsymbol language to Ada, but still return 0.
1392 Two reasons for that:
1393
1394 1. For Ada, we prefer computing the symbol's decoded name
1395 on the fly rather than pre-compute it, in order to save
1396 memory (Ada projects are typically very large).
1397
1398 2. There are some areas in the definition of the GNAT
1399 encoding where, with a bit of bad luck, we might be able
1400 to decode a non-Ada symbol, generating an incorrect
1401 demangled name (Eg: names ending with "TB" for instance
1402 are identified as task bodies and so stripped from
1403 the decoded name returned).
1404
1405 Returning 1, here, but not setting *DEMANGLED, helps us get a
1406 little bit of the best of both worlds. Because we're last,
1407 we should not affect any of the other languages that were
1408 able to demangle the symbol before us; we get to correctly
1409 tag Ada symbols as such; and even if we incorrectly tagged a
1410 non-Ada symbol, which should be rare, any routing through the
1411 Ada language should be transparent (Ada tries to behave much
1412 like C/C++ with non-Ada symbols). */
1413 return 1;
1414 }
1415
1416 return 0;
1417 }
1418
1419 \f
1420
1421 /* Arrays */
1422
1423 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure
1424 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used
1425 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest
1426 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding.
1427 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if
1428 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL.
1429
1430 The GNAT encoding used to describe the array index type evolved a bit.
1431 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each
1432 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was
1433 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected
1434 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order
1435 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global
1436 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make
1437 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being
1438 the full index type description.
1439
1440 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions
1441 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by
1442 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point,
1443 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated
1444 index subtype). */
1445
1446 void
1447 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type)
1448 {
1449 int i;
1450
1451 if (index_desc_type == NULL)
1452 return;
1453 gdb_assert (index_desc_type->num_fields () > 0);
1454
1455 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient
1456 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return
1457 now.
1458
1459 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding,
1460 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name
1461 is not equal to the field name. */
1462 if (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)->name () != NULL
1463 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)->name (),
1464 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0)
1465 return;
1466
1467 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */
1468 for (i = 0; i < index_desc_type->num_fields (); i++)
1469 {
1470 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i);
1471 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name));
1472
1473 if (raw_type)
1474 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type;
1475 }
1476 }
1477
1478 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1479 (fat pointers). */
1480
1481 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1482 level of indirection, if needed. */
1483
1484 static struct type *
1485 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1486 {
1487 if (type == NULL)
1488 return NULL;
1489 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1490 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1491 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1492
1493 if (type != NULL
1494 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1495 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1496 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1497 else
1498 return type;
1499 }
1500
1501 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1502
1503 static int
1504 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1505 {
1506 return
1507 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1508 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1509 }
1510
1511 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1512
1513 static struct type *
1514 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1515 {
1516 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1517
1518 if (base_type == NULL)
1519 return NULL;
1520 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1521 return base_type;
1522 else
1523 {
1524 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1525
1526 if (alt_type == NULL)
1527 return base_type;
1528 else
1529 return alt_type;
1530 }
1531 }
1532
1533 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1534
1535 static struct value *
1536 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1537 {
1538 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
1539 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1540
1541 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1542
1543 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1544 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1545 else
1546 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1547 }
1548
1549 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1550
1551 static int
1552 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1553 {
1554 type = desc_base_type (type);
1555 return (type != NULL && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1556 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1557 }
1558
1559 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1560 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1561
1562 static struct type *
1563 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1564 {
1565 struct type *r;
1566
1567 type = desc_base_type (type);
1568
1569 if (type == NULL)
1570 return NULL;
1571 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1572 {
1573 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1574 if (type == NULL)
1575 return NULL;
1576 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1577 if (r != NULL)
1578 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1579 }
1580 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1581 {
1582 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1583 if (r != NULL)
1584 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1585 }
1586 return NULL;
1587 }
1588
1589 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1590 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1591
1592 static struct value *
1593 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1594 {
1595 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1596
1597 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1598 {
1599 struct type *bounds_type =
1600 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1601 LONGEST addr;
1602
1603 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1604 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1605
1606 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1607 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1608 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1609 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1610 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1611 else
1612 addr = value_address (arr);
1613
1614 return
1615 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1616 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1617 }
1618
1619 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1620 {
1621 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1622 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1623 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds);
1624
1625 if (p_bounds_type
1626 && p_bounds_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1627 {
1628 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type);
1629
1630 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type))
1631 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type
1632 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)),
1633 p_bounds);
1634 }
1635 else
1636 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1637
1638 return p_bounds;
1639 }
1640 else
1641 return NULL;
1642 }
1643
1644 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1645 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1646
1647 static int
1648 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1649 {
1650 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1651 }
1652
1653 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1654 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1655
1656 static int
1657 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1658 {
1659 type = desc_base_type (type);
1660
1661 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1662 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1663 else
1664 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1665 }
1666
1667 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1668 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1669 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1670 data. */
1671
1672 static struct type *
1673 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1674 {
1675 type = desc_base_type (type);
1676
1677 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1678 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1679 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1680 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1681 {
1682 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1683
1684 if (data_type
1685 && ada_check_typedef (data_type)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1686 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type));
1687 }
1688
1689 return NULL;
1690 }
1691
1692 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1693 its array data. */
1694
1695 static struct value *
1696 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1697 {
1698 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1699
1700 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1701 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1702 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1703 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1704 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1705 else
1706 return NULL;
1707 }
1708
1709
1710 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1711 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1712
1713 static int
1714 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1715 {
1716 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1717 }
1718
1719 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1720 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1721
1722 static int
1723 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1724 {
1725 type = desc_base_type (type);
1726
1727 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1728 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1729 else
1730 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1731 }
1732
1733 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1734 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1735 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1736
1737 static struct value *
1738 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1739 {
1740 char bound_name[20];
1741 xsnprintf (bound_name, sizeof (bound_name), "%cB%d",
1742 which ? 'U' : 'L', i - 1);
1743 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name, NULL,
1744 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1745 }
1746
1747 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1748 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1749 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1750
1751 static int
1752 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1753 {
1754 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1755 }
1756
1757 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1758 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1759 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1760
1761 static int
1762 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1763 {
1764 type = desc_base_type (type);
1765
1766 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1767 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1768 else
1769 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1770 }
1771
1772 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1773 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1774
1775 static struct type *
1776 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1777 {
1778 type = desc_base_type (type);
1779
1780 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1781 {
1782 char bound_name[20];
1783 xsnprintf (bound_name, sizeof (bound_name), "LB%d", i - 1);
1784 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name, 1);
1785 }
1786 else
1787 return NULL;
1788 }
1789
1790 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1791 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1792
1793 static int
1794 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1795 {
1796 type = desc_base_type (type);
1797
1798 if (type != NULL)
1799 return type->num_fields () / 2;
1800 return 0;
1801 }
1802
1803 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1804 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1805 type). */
1806
1807 static int
1808 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1809 {
1810 if (type == NULL)
1811 return 0;
1812 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1813 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1814 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1815 }
1816
1817 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1818 * to one. */
1819
1820 static int
1821 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1822 {
1823 while (type != NULL
1824 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1825 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1826 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1827 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1828 }
1829
1830 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1831
1832 int
1833 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1834 {
1835 if (type == NULL)
1836 return 0;
1837 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1838 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1839 || (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1840 && (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))->code ()
1841 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)));
1842 }
1843
1844 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1845
1846 int
1847 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1848 {
1849 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1850
1851 if (type == NULL)
1852 return 0;
1853 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1854 return (data_type != NULL
1855 && data_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1856 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1857 }
1858
1859 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1860 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1861 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1862 is still needed. */
1863
1864 int
1865 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1866 {
1867 return
1868 type != NULL
1869 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1870 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1871 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1872 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1873 }
1874
1875
1876 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1877 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1878 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1879 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1880 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1881 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1882 a descriptor. */
1883
1884 static struct type *
1885 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1886 {
1887 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1888 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1889
1890 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1891 return value_type (arr);
1892
1893 if (!bounds)
1894 {
1895 struct type *array_type =
1896 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1897
1898 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1899 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1900 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1901
1902 return array_type;
1903 }
1904 else
1905 {
1906 struct type *elt_type;
1907 int arity;
1908 struct value *descriptor;
1909
1910 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1911 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1912
1913 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1914 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1915
1916 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1917 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1918 return NULL;
1919 while (arity > 0)
1920 {
1921 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1922 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1923 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1924 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1925
1926 arity -= 1;
1927 create_static_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1928 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1929 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1930 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1931
1932 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1933 {
1934 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as
1935 recompute the array size, because it was previously
1936 computed based on the unpacked element size. */
1937 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low);
1938 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high);
1939
1940 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1941 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1942 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already
1943 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */
1944 if (lo < hi)
1945 {
1946 int array_bitsize =
1947 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1948
1949 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8;
1950 }
1951 }
1952 }
1953
1954 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1955 }
1956 }
1957
1958 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1959 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1960 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1961 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1962
1963 struct value *
1964 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1965 {
1966 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1967 {
1968 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1969
1970 if (arrType == NULL)
1971 return NULL;
1972 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1973 }
1974 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1975 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1976 else
1977 return arr;
1978 }
1979
1980 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1981 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1982 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1983
1984 struct value *
1985 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1986 {
1987 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1988 {
1989 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1990
1991 if (arrVal == NULL)
1992 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1993 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1994 return value_ind (arrVal);
1995 }
1996 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1997 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1998 else
1999 return arr;
2000 }
2001
2002 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
2003 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
2004 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
2005
2006 struct type *
2007 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
2008 {
2009 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
2010 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
2011
2012 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
2013 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
2014
2015 return type;
2016 }
2017
2018 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
2019
2020 static int
2021 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2022 {
2023 if (type == NULL)
2024 return 0;
2025 type = desc_base_type (type);
2026 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2027 return
2028 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
2029 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
2030 }
2031
2032 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
2033 packed-array type. */
2034
2035 int
2036 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2037 {
2038 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2039 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2040 }
2041
2042 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
2043 unconstrained packed-array type. */
2044
2045 static int
2046 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2047 {
2048 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2049 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2050 }
2051
2052 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
2053 return the size of its elements in bits. */
2054
2055 static long
2056 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
2057 {
2058 const char *raw_name;
2059 const char *tail;
2060 long bits;
2061
2062 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef
2063 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type
2064 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */
2065 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2066 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
2067
2068 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2069 if (!raw_name)
2070 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2071
2072 if (!raw_name)
2073 return 0;
2074
2075 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2076 gdb_assert (tail != NULL);
2077
2078 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
2079 {
2080 lim_warning
2081 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
2082 return 0;
2083 }
2084
2085 return bits;
2086 }
2087
2088 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
2089 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
2090 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
2091 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
2092 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
2093 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
2094 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
2095 in bits.
2096
2097 Note that, for arrays whose index type has an XA encoding where
2098 a bound references a record discriminant, getting that discriminant,
2099 and therefore the actual value of that bound, is not possible
2100 because none of the given parameters gives us access to the record.
2101 This function assumes that it is OK in the context where it is being
2102 used to return an array whose bounds are still dynamic and where
2103 the length is arbitrary. */
2104
2105 static struct type *
2106 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
2107 {
2108 struct type *new_elt_type;
2109 struct type *new_type;
2110 struct type *index_type_desc;
2111 struct type *index_type;
2112 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
2113
2114 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2115 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2116 return type;
2117
2118 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2119 if (index_type_desc)
2120 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, 0),
2121 NULL);
2122 else
2123 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2124
2125 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
2126 new_elt_type =
2127 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2128 elt_bits);
2129 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, index_type);
2130 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
2131 new_type->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
2132
2133 if ((check_typedef (index_type)->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
2134 && is_dynamic_type (check_typedef (index_type)))
2135 || get_discrete_bounds (index_type, &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
2136 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
2137 if (high_bound < low_bound)
2138 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
2139 else
2140 {
2141 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
2142 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
2143 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2144 }
2145
2146 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
2147 return new_type;
2148 }
2149
2150 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
2151 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
2152
2153 static struct type *
2154 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2155 {
2156 const char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2157 char *name;
2158 const char *tail;
2159 struct type *shadow_type;
2160 long bits;
2161
2162 if (!raw_name)
2163 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2164
2165 if (!raw_name)
2166 return NULL;
2167
2168 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
2169 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2170 type = desc_base_type (type);
2171
2172 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
2173 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
2174
2175 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
2176
2177 if (shadow_type == NULL)
2178 {
2179 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
2180 return NULL;
2181 }
2182 shadow_type = check_typedef (shadow_type);
2183
2184 if (shadow_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2185 {
2186 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds "
2187 "information on packed array"));
2188 return NULL;
2189 }
2190
2191 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
2192 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
2193 }
2194
2195 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
2196 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
2197 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
2198 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
2199 type length is set appropriately. */
2200
2201 static struct value *
2202 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
2203 {
2204 struct type *type;
2205
2206 /* If our value is a pointer, then dereference it. Likewise if
2207 the value is a reference. Make sure that this operation does not
2208 cause the target type to be fixed, as this would indirectly cause
2209 this array to be decoded. The rest of the routine assumes that
2210 the array hasn't been decoded yet, so we use the basic "coerce_ref"
2211 and "value_ind" routines to perform the dereferencing, as opposed
2212 to using "ada_coerce_ref" or "ada_value_ind". */
2213 arr = coerce_ref (arr);
2214 if (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2215 arr = value_ind (arr);
2216
2217 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
2218 if (type == NULL)
2219 {
2220 error (_("can't unpack array"));
2221 return NULL;
2222 }
2223
2224 if (type_byte_order (value_type (arr)) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG
2225 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
2226 {
2227 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
2228 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
2229 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
2230 first left-justify it. */
2231 int bit_size, bit_pos;
2232 ULONGEST mod;
2233
2234 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
2235 bit_size = 0;
2236 while (mod > 0)
2237 {
2238 bit_size += 1;
2239 mod >>= 1;
2240 }
2241 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
2242 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
2243 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2244 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2245 bit_size,
2246 type);
2247 }
2248
2249 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
2250 }
2251
2252
2253 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
2254 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
2255
2256 static struct value *
2257 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2258 {
2259 int i;
2260 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
2261 long elt_total_bit_offset;
2262 struct type *elt_type;
2263 struct value *v;
2264
2265 bits = 0;
2266 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
2267 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2268 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
2269 {
2270 if (elt_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2271 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
2272 error
2273 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of "
2274 "something other than a packed array"));
2275 else
2276 {
2277 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2278 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
2279 LONGEST idx;
2280
2281 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
2282 {
2283 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
2284 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
2285 }
2286
2287 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
2288 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
2289 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"),
2290 (long) idx);
2291 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2292 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
2293 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2294 }
2295 }
2296 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2297 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2298
2299 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
2300 bits, elt_type);
2301 return v;
2302 }
2303
2304 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2305
2306 static int
2307 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2308 {
2309 switch (type->code ())
2310 {
2311 default:
2312 return 0;
2313 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2314 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2315 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2316 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) - TYPE_RANGE_DATA (type)->bias < 0;
2317 }
2318 }
2319
2320 /* With SRC being a buffer containing BIT_SIZE bits of data at BIT_OFFSET,
2321 unpack that data into UNPACKED. UNPACKED_LEN is the size in bytes of
2322 the unpacked buffer.
2323
2324 The size of the unpacked buffer (UNPACKED_LEN) is expected to be large
2325 enough to contain at least BIT_OFFSET bits. If not, an error is raised.
2326
2327 IS_BIG_ENDIAN is nonzero if the data is stored in big endian mode,
2328 zero otherwise.
2329
2330 IS_SIGNED_TYPE is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type.
2331
2332 IS_SCALAR is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type. */
2333
2334 static void
2335 ada_unpack_from_contents (const gdb_byte *src, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2336 gdb_byte *unpacked, int unpacked_len,
2337 int is_big_endian, int is_signed_type,
2338 int is_scalar)
2339 {
2340 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2341 int src_idx; /* Index into the source area */
2342 int src_bytes_left; /* Number of source bytes left to process. */
2343 int srcBitsLeft; /* Number of source bits left to move */
2344 int unusedLS; /* Number of bits in next significant
2345 byte of source that are unused */
2346
2347 int unpacked_idx; /* Index into the unpacked buffer */
2348 int unpacked_bytes_left; /* Number of bytes left to set in unpacked. */
2349
2350 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2351 int accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2352 unsigned char sign;
2353
2354 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2355 the indices move. */
2356 int delta = is_big_endian ? -1 : 1;
2357
2358 /* Make sure that unpacked is large enough to receive the BIT_SIZE
2359 bits from SRC. .*/
2360 if ((bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT > unpacked_len)
2361 error (_("Cannot unpack %d bits into buffer of %d bytes"),
2362 bit_size, unpacked_len);
2363
2364 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2365 src_bytes_left = src_len;
2366 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_len;
2367 sign = 0;
2368
2369 if (is_big_endian)
2370 {
2371 src_idx = src_len - 1;
2372 if (is_signed_type
2373 && ((src[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2374 sign = ~0;
2375
2376 unusedLS =
2377 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2378 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2379
2380 if (is_scalar)
2381 {
2382 accumSize = 0;
2383 unpacked_idx = unpacked_len - 1;
2384 }
2385 else
2386 {
2387 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2388 accumSize =
2389 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2390 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2391 of the target. */
2392 unpacked_idx = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2393 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_idx + 1;
2394 }
2395 }
2396 else
2397 {
2398 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2399
2400 src_idx = unpacked_idx = 0;
2401 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2402 accumSize = 0;
2403
2404 if (is_signed_type && (src[src_len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2405 sign = ~0;
2406 }
2407
2408 accum = 0;
2409 while (src_bytes_left > 0)
2410 {
2411 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2412 part of the value. */
2413 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2414 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2415 1;
2416 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2417 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2418
2419 accum |=
2420 (((src[src_idx] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2421 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2422 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2423 {
2424 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2425 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2426 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2427 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1;
2428 unpacked_idx += delta;
2429 }
2430 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2431 unusedLS = 0;
2432 src_bytes_left -= 1;
2433 src_idx += delta;
2434 }
2435 while (unpacked_bytes_left > 0)
2436 {
2437 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2438 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2439 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2440 if (accumSize < 0)
2441 accumSize = 0;
2442 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2443 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1;
2444 unpacked_idx += delta;
2445 }
2446 }
2447
2448 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2449 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2450 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2451 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2452 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2453 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2454 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2455 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2456
2457 struct value *
2458 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2459 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2460 struct type *type)
2461 {
2462 struct value *v;
2463 const gdb_byte *src; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2464 gdb_byte *unpacked;
2465 const int is_scalar = is_scalar_type (type);
2466 const int is_big_endian = type_byte_order (type) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG;
2467 gdb::byte_vector staging;
2468
2469 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2470
2471 if (obj == NULL)
2472 src = valaddr + offset;
2473 else
2474 src = value_contents (obj) + offset;
2475
2476 if (is_dynamic_type (type))
2477 {
2478 /* The length of TYPE might by dynamic, so we need to resolve
2479 TYPE in order to know its actual size, which we then use
2480 to create the contents buffer of the value we return.
2481 The difficulty is that the data containing our object is
2482 packed, and therefore maybe not at a byte boundary. So, what
2483 we do, is unpack the data into a byte-aligned buffer, and then
2484 use that buffer as our object's value for resolving the type. */
2485 int staging_len = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2486 staging.resize (staging_len);
2487
2488 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size,
2489 staging.data (), staging.size (),
2490 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type),
2491 is_scalar);
2492 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, staging, 0);
2493 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) < (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2494 {
2495 /* This happens when the length of the object is dynamic,
2496 and is actually smaller than the space reserved for it.
2497 For instance, in an array of variant records, the bit_size
2498 we're given is the array stride, which is constant and
2499 normally equal to the maximum size of its element.
2500 But, in reality, each element only actually spans a portion
2501 of that stride. */
2502 bit_size = TYPE_LENGTH (type) * HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2503 }
2504 }
2505
2506 if (obj == NULL)
2507 {
2508 v = allocate_value (type);
2509 src = valaddr + offset;
2510 }
2511 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2512 {
2513 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2514 gdb_byte *buf;
2515
2516 v = value_at (type, value_address (obj) + offset);
2517 buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (src_len);
2518 read_memory (value_address (v), buf, src_len);
2519 src = buf;
2520 }
2521 else
2522 {
2523 v = allocate_value (type);
2524 src = value_contents (obj) + offset;
2525 }
2526
2527 if (obj != NULL)
2528 {
2529 long new_offset = offset;
2530
2531 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2532 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2533 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2534 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2535 {
2536 ++new_offset;
2537 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2538 }
2539 set_value_offset (v, new_offset);
2540
2541 /* Also set the parent value. This is needed when trying to
2542 assign a new value (in inferior memory). */
2543 set_value_parent (v, obj);
2544 }
2545 else
2546 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2547 unpacked = value_contents_writeable (v);
2548
2549 if (bit_size == 0)
2550 {
2551 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2552 return v;
2553 }
2554
2555 if (staging.size () == TYPE_LENGTH (type))
2556 {
2557 /* Small short-cut: If we've unpacked the data into a buffer
2558 of the same size as TYPE's length, then we can reuse that,
2559 instead of doing the unpacking again. */
2560 memcpy (unpacked, staging.data (), staging.size ());
2561 }
2562 else
2563 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size,
2564 unpacked, TYPE_LENGTH (type),
2565 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type), is_scalar);
2566
2567 return v;
2568 }
2569
2570 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2571 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2572 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2573 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2574
2575 static struct value *
2576 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2577 {
2578 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2579 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2580
2581 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2582 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2583
2584 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2585 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2586 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2587 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2588
2589 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2590 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2591
2592 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2593 && bits > 0
2594 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2595 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2596 {
2597 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2598 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2599 int from_size;
2600 gdb_byte *buffer = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
2601 struct value *val;
2602 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2603
2604 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2605 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2606
2607 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2608 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2609 if (from_size == 0)
2610 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2611
2612 const int is_big_endian = type_byte_order (type) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG;
2613 ULONGEST from_offset = 0;
2614 if (is_big_endian && is_scalar_type (value_type (fromval)))
2615 from_offset = from_size - bits;
2616 copy_bitwise (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2617 value_contents (fromval), from_offset,
2618 bits, is_big_endian);
2619 write_memory_with_notification (to_addr, buffer, len);
2620
2621 val = value_copy (toval);
2622 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2623 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2624 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2625
2626 return val;
2627 }
2628
2629 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2630 }
2631
2632
2633 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2634 CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2635 CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2636 COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2637 of COMPONENT are ignored.
2638
2639 Although not part of the initial design, this function also works
2640 when CONTAINER and COMPONENT are not_lval's: it works as if CONTAINER
2641 had a null address, and COMPONENT had an address which is equal to
2642 its offset inside CONTAINER. */
2643
2644 static void
2645 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2646 struct value *val)
2647 {
2648 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2649 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2650 int bit_offset_in_container =
2651 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2652 int bits;
2653
2654 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2655
2656 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2657 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2658 else
2659 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2660
2661 if (type_byte_order (value_type (container)) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG)
2662 {
2663 int src_offset;
2664
2665 if (is_scalar_type (check_typedef (value_type (component))))
2666 src_offset
2667 = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits;
2668 else
2669 src_offset = 0;
2670 copy_bitwise (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2671 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2672 value_contents (val), src_offset, bits, 1);
2673 }
2674 else
2675 copy_bitwise (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2676 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2677 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2678 }
2679
2680 /* Determine if TYPE is an access to an unconstrained array. */
2681
2682 bool
2683 ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (struct type *type)
2684 {
2685 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
2686 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type)));
2687 }
2688
2689 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2690 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2691 thereto. */
2692
2693 struct value *
2694 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2695 {
2696 int k;
2697 struct value *elt;
2698 struct type *elt_type;
2699
2700 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2701
2702 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2703 if (elt_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2704 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2705 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2706
2707 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2708 {
2709 struct type *saved_elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type);
2710
2711 if (elt_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2712 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2713
2714 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2715
2716 if (ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (saved_elt_type)
2717 && value_type (elt)->code () != TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2718 {
2719 /* The element is a typedef to an unconstrained array,
2720 except that the value_subscript call stripped the
2721 typedef layer. The typedef layer is GNAT's way to
2722 specify that the element is, at the source level, an
2723 access to the unconstrained array, rather than the
2724 unconstrained array. So, we need to restore that
2725 typedef layer, which we can do by forcing the element's
2726 type back to its original type. Otherwise, the returned
2727 value is going to be printed as the array, rather
2728 than as an access. Another symptom of the same issue
2729 would be that an expression trying to dereference the
2730 element would also be improperly rejected. */
2731 deprecated_set_value_type (elt, saved_elt_type);
2732 }
2733
2734 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2735 }
2736
2737 return elt;
2738 }
2739
2740 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a GDB array, the value of the element
2741 of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2742 Does not read the entire array into memory.
2743
2744 Note: Unlike what one would expect, this function is used instead of
2745 ada_value_subscript for basically all non-packed array types. The reason
2746 for this is that a side effect of doing our own pointer arithmetics instead
2747 of relying on value_subscript is that there is no implicit typedef peeling.
2748 This is important for arrays of array accesses, where it allows us to
2749 preserve the fact that the array's element is an array access, where the
2750 access part os encoded in a typedef layer. */
2751
2752 static struct value *
2753 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2754 {
2755 int k;
2756 struct value *array_ind = ada_value_ind (arr);
2757 struct type *type
2758 = check_typedef (value_enclosing_type (array_ind));
2759
2760 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2761 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
2762 return value_subscript_packed (array_ind, arity, ind);
2763
2764 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2765 {
2766 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2767
2768 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2769 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2770 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2771 value_copy (arr));
2772 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2773 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - lwb);
2774 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2775 }
2776
2777 return value_ind (arr);
2778 }
2779
2780 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2781 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of
2782 HIGH'Pos-LOW'Pos+1 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of
2783 this array is LOW, as per Ada rules. */
2784 static struct value *
2785 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2786 int low, int high)
2787 {
2788 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type);
2789 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2790 struct type *index_type
2791 = create_static_range_type (NULL, base_index_type, low, high);
2792 struct type *slice_type = create_array_type_with_stride
2793 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type,
2794 type0->dyn_prop (DYN_PROP_BYTE_STRIDE),
2795 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0));
2796 int base_low = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2797 LONGEST base_low_pos, low_pos;
2798 CORE_ADDR base;
2799
2800 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2801 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, base_low, &base_low_pos))
2802 {
2803 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2804 low_pos = low;
2805 base_low_pos = base_low;
2806 }
2807
2808 base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2809 + ((low_pos - base_low_pos)
2810 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)));
2811 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2812 }
2813
2814
2815 static struct value *
2816 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2817 {
2818 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
2819 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2820 struct type *index_type
2821 = create_static_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2822 struct type *slice_type = create_array_type_with_stride
2823 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type,
2824 type->dyn_prop (DYN_PROP_BYTE_STRIDE),
2825 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0));
2826 LONGEST low_pos, high_pos;
2827
2828 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2829 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, high, &high_pos))
2830 {
2831 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2832 low_pos = low;
2833 high_pos = high;
2834 }
2835
2836 return value_cast (slice_type,
2837 value_slice (array, low, high_pos - low_pos + 1));
2838 }
2839
2840 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2841 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2842 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2843 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2844
2845 int
2846 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2847 {
2848 int arity;
2849
2850 if (type == NULL)
2851 return 0;
2852
2853 type = desc_base_type (type);
2854
2855 arity = 0;
2856 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2857 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2858 else
2859 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2860 {
2861 arity += 1;
2862 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2863 }
2864
2865 return arity;
2866 }
2867
2868 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2869 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2870 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2871 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2872
2873 struct type *
2874 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2875 {
2876 type = desc_base_type (type);
2877
2878 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2879 {
2880 int k;
2881 struct type *p_array_type;
2882
2883 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2884
2885 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2886 if (k == 0)
2887 return NULL;
2888
2889 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2890 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2891 k = nindices;
2892 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2893 {
2894 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2895 k -= 1;
2896 }
2897 return p_array_type;
2898 }
2899 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2900 {
2901 while (nindices != 0 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2902 {
2903 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2904 nindices -= 1;
2905 }
2906 return type;
2907 }
2908
2909 return NULL;
2910 }
2911
2912 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2913 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2914 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2915 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2916 the error message. */
2917
2918 static struct type *
2919 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2920 {
2921 struct type *result_type;
2922
2923 type = desc_base_type (type);
2924
2925 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2926 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2927
2928 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2929 {
2930 int i;
2931
2932 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2933 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2934 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2935 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2936 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2937 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2938 if (result_type && result_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2939 result_type = NULL;
2940 }
2941 else
2942 {
2943 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2944 if (result_type == NULL)
2945 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2946 }
2947
2948 return result_type;
2949 }
2950
2951 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2952 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2953 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2954 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2955 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2956
2957 static LONGEST
2958 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type *arr_type, int n, int which)
2959 {
2960 struct type *type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2961 int i;
2962
2963 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2964
2965 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2966 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2967
2968 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2969 return (LONGEST) - which;
2970
2971 if (arr_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2972 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2973 else
2974 type = arr_type;
2975
2976 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type))
2977 {
2978 /* The array has already been fixed, so we do not need to
2979 check the parallel ___XA type again. That encoding has
2980 already been applied, so ignore it now. */
2981 index_type_desc = NULL;
2982 }
2983 else
2984 {
2985 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2986 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
2987 }
2988
2989 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2990 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2991 NULL);
2992 else
2993 {
2994 struct type *elt_type = check_typedef (type);
2995
2996 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
2997 elt_type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2998
2999 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
3000 }
3001
3002 return
3003 (LONGEST) (which == 0
3004 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
3005 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
3006 }
3007
3008 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
3009 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
3010 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3011 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
3012
3013 static LONGEST
3014 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
3015 {
3016 struct type *arr_type;
3017
3018 if (check_typedef (value_type (arr))->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3019 arr = value_ind (arr);
3020 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3021
3022 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3023 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
3024 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3025 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
3026 else
3027 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
3028 }
3029
3030 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
3031 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3032 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
3033 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
3034 clauses at the moment. */
3035
3036 static LONGEST
3037 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
3038 {
3039 struct type *arr_type, *index_type;
3040 int low, high;
3041
3042 if (check_typedef (value_type (arr))->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3043 arr = value_ind (arr);
3044 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3045
3046 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3047 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
3048
3049 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3050 {
3051 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0);
3052 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1);
3053 }
3054 else
3055 {
3056 low = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0));
3057 high = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1));
3058 }
3059
3060 arr_type = check_typedef (arr_type);
3061 index_type = ada_index_type (arr_type, n, "length");
3062 if (index_type != NULL)
3063 {
3064 struct type *base_type;
3065 if (index_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
3066 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (index_type);
3067 else
3068 base_type = index_type;
3069
3070 low = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, low));
3071 high = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, high));
3072 }
3073 return high - low + 1;
3074 }
3075
3076 /* An array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type), with
3077 bounds LOW to HIGH, but whose contents are unimportant. If HIGH is
3078 less than LOW, then LOW-1 is used. */
3079
3080 static struct value *
3081 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low, int high)
3082 {
3083 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type);
3084 struct type *index_type
3085 = create_static_range_type
3086 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)), low,
3087 high < low ? low - 1 : high);
3088 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1);
3089
3090 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
3091 }
3092 \f
3093
3094 /* Name resolution */
3095
3096 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
3097 to OP. */
3098
3099 static const char *
3100 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
3101 {
3102 int i;
3103
3104 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
3105 {
3106 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
3107 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
3108 }
3109 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
3110 }
3111
3112 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3113 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3114 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3115 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3116 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3117
3118 static int
3119 encoded_ordered_before (const char *N0, const char *N1)
3120 {
3121 if (N1 == NULL)
3122 return 0;
3123 else if (N0 == NULL)
3124 return 1;
3125 else
3126 {
3127 int k0, k1;
3128
3129 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3130 ;
3131 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3132 ;
3133 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3134 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3135 {
3136 int n0, n1;
3137
3138 n0 = k0;
3139 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3140 n0 -= 1;
3141 n1 = k1;
3142 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3143 n1 -= 1;
3144 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3145 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3146 }
3147 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3148 }
3149 }
3150
3151 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3152 encoded names. */
3153
3154 static void
3155 sort_choices (struct block_symbol syms[], int nsyms)
3156 {
3157 int i;
3158
3159 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3160 {
3161 struct block_symbol sym = syms[i];
3162 int j;
3163
3164 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3165 {
3166 if (encoded_ordered_before (syms[j].symbol->linkage_name (),
3167 sym.symbol->linkage_name ()))
3168 break;
3169 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3170 }
3171 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3172 }
3173 }
3174
3175 /* Whether GDB should display formals and return types for functions in the
3176 overloads selection menu. */
3177 static bool print_signatures = true;
3178
3179 /* Print the signature for SYM on STREAM according to the FLAGS options. For
3180 all but functions, the signature is just the name of the symbol. For
3181 functions, this is the name of the function, the list of types for formals
3182 and the return type (if any). */
3183
3184 static void
3185 ada_print_symbol_signature (struct ui_file *stream, struct symbol *sym,
3186 const struct type_print_options *flags)
3187 {
3188 struct type *type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
3189
3190 fprintf_filtered (stream, "%s", sym->print_name ());
3191 if (!print_signatures
3192 || type == NULL
3193 || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3194 return;
3195
3196 if (type->num_fields () > 0)
3197 {
3198 int i;
3199
3200 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
3201 for (i = 0; i < type->num_fields (); ++i)
3202 {
3203 if (i > 0)
3204 fprintf_filtered (stream, "; ");
3205 ada_print_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), NULL, stream, -1, 0,
3206 flags);
3207 }
3208 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
3209 }
3210 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != NULL
3211 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)->code () != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
3212 {
3213 fprintf_filtered (stream, " return ");
3214 ada_print_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, stream, -1, 0, flags);
3215 }
3216 }
3217
3218 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3219 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3220 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3221
3222 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3223 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3224
3225 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3226 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3227 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3228
3229 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3230
3231 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3232 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3233
3234 static int
3235 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3236 int is_all_choice, const char *annotation_suffix)
3237 {
3238 const char *args;
3239 const char *prompt;
3240 int n_chosen;
3241 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3242
3243 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3244 if (prompt == NULL)
3245 prompt = "> ";
3246
3247 args = command_line_input (prompt, annotation_suffix);
3248
3249 if (args == NULL)
3250 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3251
3252 n_chosen = 0;
3253
3254 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3255 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3256 while (1)
3257 {
3258 char *args2;
3259 int choice, j;
3260
3261 args = skip_spaces (args);
3262 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3263 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3264 else if (*args == '\0')
3265 break;
3266
3267 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3268 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3269 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3270 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3271 args = args2;
3272
3273 if (choice == 0)
3274 error (_("cancelled"));
3275
3276 if (choice < first_choice)
3277 {
3278 n_chosen = n_choices;
3279 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3280 choices[j] = j;
3281 break;
3282 }
3283 choice -= first_choice;
3284
3285 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3286 {
3287 }
3288
3289 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3290 {
3291 int k;
3292
3293 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3294 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3295 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3296 n_chosen += 1;
3297 }
3298 }
3299
3300 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3301 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3302
3303 return n_chosen;
3304 }
3305
3306 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3307 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3308 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3309 selected. */
3310
3311 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3312 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3313
3314 static int
3315 user_select_syms (struct block_symbol *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3316 {
3317 int i;
3318 int *chosen = XALLOCAVEC (int , nsyms);
3319 int n_chosen;
3320 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3321 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3322
3323 if (max_results < 1)
3324 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3325 if (nsyms <= 1)
3326 return nsyms;
3327
3328 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3329 error (_("\
3330 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3331 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3332
3333 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3334 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3335 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3336 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3337 return nsyms;
3338
3339 printf_filtered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3340 if (max_results > 1)
3341 printf_filtered (_("[1] all\n"));
3342
3343 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3344
3345 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3346 {
3347 if (syms[i].symbol == NULL)
3348 continue;
3349
3350 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_BLOCK)
3351 {
3352 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3353 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].symbol, 1);
3354
3355 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3356 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3357 &type_print_raw_options);
3358 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3359 printf_filtered (_(" at %p[<no source file available>%p]:%d\n"),
3360 metadata_style.style ().ptr (), nullptr, sal.line);
3361 else
3362 printf_filtered
3363 (_(" at %ps:%d\n"),
3364 styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
3365 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal.symtab)),
3366 sal.line);
3367 continue;
3368 }
3369 else
3370 {
3371 int is_enumeral =
3372 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_CONST
3373 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol) != NULL
3374 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3375 struct symtab *symtab = NULL;
3376
3377 if (SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (syms[i].symbol))
3378 symtab = symbol_symtab (syms[i].symbol);
3379
3380 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3381 {
3382 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3383 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3384 &type_print_raw_options);
3385 printf_filtered (_(" at %s:%d\n"),
3386 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab),
3387 SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol));
3388 }
3389 else if (is_enumeral
3390 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->name () != NULL)
3391 {
3392 printf_filtered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3393 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol), NULL,
3394 gdb_stdout, -1, 0, &type_print_raw_options);
3395 printf_filtered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3396 syms[i].symbol->print_name ());
3397 }
3398 else
3399 {
3400 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3401 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3402 &type_print_raw_options);
3403
3404 if (symtab != NULL)
3405 printf_filtered (is_enumeral
3406 ? _(" in %s (enumeral)\n")
3407 : _(" at %s:?\n"),
3408 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab));
3409 else
3410 printf_filtered (is_enumeral
3411 ? _(" (enumeral)\n")
3412 : _(" at ?\n"));
3413 }
3414 }
3415 }
3416
3417 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3418 "overload-choice");
3419
3420 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3421 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3422
3423 return n_chosen;
3424 }
3425
3426 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
3427 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
3428 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
3429 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
3430 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
3431 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
3432 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
3433 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
3434
3435 static void
3436 resolve (expression_up *expp, int void_context_p, int parse_completion,
3437 innermost_block_tracker *tracker)
3438 {
3439 struct type *context_type = NULL;
3440 int pc = 0;
3441
3442 if (void_context_p)
3443 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
3444
3445 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type, parse_completion, tracker);
3446 }
3447
3448 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
3449 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
3450 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
3451 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
3452 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
3453 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
3454 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
3455 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
3456
3457 static struct value *
3458 resolve_subexp (expression_up *expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
3459 struct type *context_type, int parse_completion,
3460 innermost_block_tracker *tracker)
3461 {
3462 int pc = *pos;
3463 int i;
3464 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
3465 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
3466 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
3467 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
3468 int oplen;
3469
3470 argvec = NULL;
3471 nargs = 0;
3472 exp = expp->get ();
3473
3474 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
3475 if needed. */
3476 switch (op)
3477 {
3478 case OP_FUNCALL:
3479 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3480 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3481 *pos += 7;
3482 else
3483 {
3484 *pos += 3;
3485 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3486 }
3487 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
3488 break;
3489
3490 case UNOP_ADDR:
3491 *pos += 1;
3492 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3493 break;
3494
3495 case UNOP_QUAL:
3496 *pos += 3;
3497 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type),
3498 parse_completion, tracker);
3499 break;
3500
3501 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
3502 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
3503 case OP_ATR_TAG:
3504 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
3505 case OP_ATR_LAST:
3506 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
3507 case OP_ATR_POS:
3508 case OP_ATR_VAL:
3509 case OP_ATR_MIN:
3510 case OP_ATR_MAX:
3511 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
3512 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
3513 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
3514 case OP_AGGREGATE:
3515 case OP_OTHERS:
3516 case OP_CHOICES:
3517 case OP_POSITIONAL:
3518 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
3519 case OP_NAME:
3520 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
3521 *pos += oplen;
3522 break;
3523
3524 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
3525 {
3526 struct value *arg1;
3527
3528 *pos += 1;
3529 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3530 if (arg1 == NULL)
3531 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3532 else
3533 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1), parse_completion,
3534 tracker);
3535 break;
3536 }
3537
3538 case UNOP_CAST:
3539 *pos += 3;
3540 nargs = 1;
3541 break;
3542
3543 case BINOP_ADD:
3544 case BINOP_SUB:
3545 case BINOP_MUL:
3546 case BINOP_DIV:
3547 case BINOP_REM:
3548 case BINOP_MOD:
3549 case BINOP_EXP:
3550 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3551 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
3552 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
3553 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3554 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3555 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3556
3557 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3558 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3559 case BINOP_LESS:
3560 case BINOP_GTR:
3561 case BINOP_LEQ:
3562 case BINOP_GEQ:
3563
3564 case BINOP_REPEAT:
3565 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
3566 case BINOP_COMMA:
3567 *pos += 1;
3568 nargs = 2;
3569 break;
3570
3571 case UNOP_NEG:
3572 case UNOP_PLUS:
3573 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3574 case UNOP_ABS:
3575 case UNOP_IND:
3576 *pos += 1;
3577 nargs = 1;
3578 break;
3579
3580 case OP_LONG:
3581 case OP_FLOAT:
3582 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3583 case OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE:
3584 *pos += 4;
3585 break;
3586
3587 case OP_TYPE:
3588 case OP_BOOL:
3589 case OP_LAST:
3590 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
3591 *pos += 3;
3592 break;
3593
3594 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
3595 *pos += 3;
3596 nargs = 1;
3597 break;
3598
3599 case OP_REGISTER:
3600 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3601 break;
3602
3603 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
3604 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3605 nargs = 1;
3606 break;
3607
3608 case TERNOP_SLICE:
3609 *pos += 1;
3610 nargs = 3;
3611 break;
3612
3613 case OP_STRING:
3614 break;
3615
3616 default:
3617 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
3618 }
3619
3620 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 1);
3621 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
3622 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL, parse_completion,
3623 tracker);
3624 argvec[i] = NULL;
3625 exp = expp->get ();
3626
3627 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
3628 switch (op)
3629 {
3630 default:
3631 break;
3632
3633 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3634 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3635 {
3636 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3637 int n_candidates;
3638
3639 n_candidates =
3640 ada_lookup_symbol_list (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->linkage_name (),
3641 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3642 &candidates);
3643
3644 if (n_candidates > 1)
3645 {
3646 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
3647 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
3648 out all types. */
3649 int j;
3650 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
3651 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol))
3652 {
3653 case LOC_REGISTER:
3654 case LOC_ARG:
3655 case LOC_REF_ARG:
3656 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
3657 case LOC_LOCAL:
3658 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3659 goto FoundNonType;
3660 default:
3661 break;
3662 }
3663 FoundNonType:
3664 if (j < n_candidates)
3665 {
3666 j = 0;
3667 while (j < n_candidates)
3668 {
3669 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
3670 {
3671 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
3672 n_candidates -= 1;
3673 }
3674 else
3675 j += 1;
3676 }
3677 }
3678 }
3679
3680 if (n_candidates == 0)
3681 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
3682 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3683 else if (n_candidates == 1)
3684 i = 0;
3685 else if (deprocedure_p
3686 && !is_nonfunction (candidates.data (), n_candidates))
3687 {
3688 i = ada_resolve_function
3689 (candidates.data (), n_candidates, NULL, 0,
3690 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->linkage_name (),
3691 context_type, parse_completion);
3692 if (i < 0)
3693 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3694 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3695 }
3696 else
3697 {
3698 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
3699 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3700 user_select_syms (candidates.data (), n_candidates, 1);
3701 i = 0;
3702 }
3703
3704 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
3705 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].symbol;
3706 tracker->update (candidates[i]);
3707 }
3708
3709 if (deprocedure_p
3710 && (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)->code ()
3711 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
3712 {
3713 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 4,
3714 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
3715 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
3716 exp = expp->get ();
3717 }
3718 break;
3719
3720 case OP_FUNCALL:
3721 {
3722 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3723 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3724 {
3725 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3726 int n_candidates;
3727
3728 n_candidates =
3729 ada_lookup_symbol_list (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->linkage_name (),
3730 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3731 &candidates);
3732
3733 if (n_candidates == 1)
3734 i = 0;
3735 else
3736 {
3737 i = ada_resolve_function
3738 (candidates.data (), n_candidates,
3739 argvec, nargs,
3740 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->linkage_name (),
3741 context_type, parse_completion);
3742 if (i < 0)
3743 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3744 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->print_name ());
3745 }
3746
3747 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
3748 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].symbol;
3749 tracker->update (candidates[i]);
3750 }
3751 }
3752 break;
3753 case BINOP_ADD:
3754 case BINOP_SUB:
3755 case BINOP_MUL:
3756 case BINOP_DIV:
3757 case BINOP_REM:
3758 case BINOP_MOD:
3759 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3760 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3761 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3762 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3763 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3764 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3765 case BINOP_LESS:
3766 case BINOP_GTR:
3767 case BINOP_LEQ:
3768 case BINOP_GEQ:
3769 case BINOP_EXP:
3770 case UNOP_NEG:
3771 case UNOP_PLUS:
3772 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3773 case UNOP_ABS:
3774 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3775 {
3776 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3777 int n_candidates;
3778
3779 n_candidates =
3780 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_decoded_op_name (op),
3781 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3782 &candidates);
3783
3784 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates.data (), n_candidates, argvec,
3785 nargs, ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL,
3786 parse_completion);
3787 if (i < 0)
3788 break;
3789
3790 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3791 candidates[i].symbol,
3792 candidates[i].block);
3793 exp = expp->get ();
3794 }
3795 break;
3796
3797 case OP_TYPE:
3798 case OP_REGISTER:
3799 return NULL;
3800 }
3801
3802 *pos = pc;
3803 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE)
3804 return evaluate_var_msym_value (EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS,
3805 exp->elts[pc + 1].objfile,
3806 exp->elts[pc + 2].msymbol);
3807 else
3808 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3809 }
3810
3811 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3812 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3813 a non-pointer. */
3814 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3815 liberal. */
3816
3817 static int
3818 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3819 {
3820 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3821 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3822
3823 if (ftype->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3824 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3825 if (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3826 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3827
3828 switch (ftype->code ())
3829 {
3830 default:
3831 return ftype->code () == atype->code ();
3832 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3833 if (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3834 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3835 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3836 else
3837 return (may_deref
3838 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3839 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3840 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3841 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3842 switch (atype->code ())
3843 {
3844 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3845 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3846 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3847 return 1;
3848 default:
3849 return 0;
3850 }
3851
3852 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3853 return (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3854 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3855
3856 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3857 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3858 return (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3859 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3860 else
3861 return (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3862 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3863
3864 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3865 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3866 return (atype->code () == ftype->code ());
3867 }
3868 }
3869
3870 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3871 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3872 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3873 argument function. */
3874
3875 static int
3876 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3877 {
3878 int i;
3879 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3880
3881 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3882 && func_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3883 return (n_actuals == 0);
3884 else if (func_type == NULL || func_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3885 return 0;
3886
3887 if (func_type->num_fields () != n_actuals)
3888 return 0;
3889
3890 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3891 {
3892 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3893 return 0;
3894 else
3895 {
3896 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type,
3897 i));
3898 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3899
3900 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3901 return 0;
3902 }
3903 }
3904 return 1;
3905 }
3906
3907 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3908 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3909 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3910 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3911
3912 static int
3913 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3914 {
3915 struct type *return_type;
3916
3917 if (func_type == NULL)
3918 return 1;
3919
3920 if (func_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3921 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3922 else
3923 return_type = get_base_type (func_type);
3924 if (return_type == NULL)
3925 return 1;
3926
3927 context_type = get_base_type (context_type);
3928
3929 if (return_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3930 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3931 else if (context_type == NULL)
3932 return return_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3933 else
3934 return return_type->code () == context_type->code ();
3935 }
3936
3937
3938 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3939 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3940 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3941 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3942 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3943 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3944
3945 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3946 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3947 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3948 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3949
3950 static int
3951 ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol syms[],
3952 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3953 const char *name, struct type *context_type,
3954 int parse_completion)
3955 {
3956 int fallback;
3957 int k;
3958 int m; /* Number of hits */
3959
3960 m = 0;
3961 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3962 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3963 where every function is accepted. */
3964 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3965 {
3966 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3967 {
3968 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].symbol));
3969
3970 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].symbol, args, nargs)
3971 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3972 {
3973 syms[m] = syms[k];
3974 m += 1;
3975 }
3976 }
3977 }
3978
3979 /* If we got multiple matches, ask the user which one to use. Don't do this
3980 interactive thing during completion, though, as the purpose of the
3981 completion is providing a list of all possible matches. Prompting the
3982 user to filter it down would be completely unexpected in this case. */
3983 if (m == 0)
3984 return -1;
3985 else if (m > 1 && !parse_completion)
3986 {
3987 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3988 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3989 return 0;
3990 }
3991 return 0;
3992 }
3993
3994 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3995 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3996 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3997
3998 static void
3999 replace_operator_with_call (expression_up *expp, int pc, int nargs,
4000 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
4001 const struct block *block)
4002 {
4003 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
4004 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
4005 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
4006 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
4007 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
4008 struct expression *exp = expp->get ();
4009
4010 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
4011 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
4012 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch;
4013 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
4014 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
4015 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
4016
4017 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
4018 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
4019
4020 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
4021 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
4022 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
4023
4024 expp->reset (newexp);
4025 }
4026
4027 /* Type-class predicates */
4028
4029 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
4030 or FLOAT). */
4031
4032 static int
4033 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
4034 {
4035 if (type == NULL)
4036 return 0;
4037 else
4038 {
4039 switch (type->code ())
4040 {
4041 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4042 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
4043 return 1;
4044 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4045 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
4046 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
4047 default:
4048 return 0;
4049 }
4050 }
4051 }
4052
4053 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
4054
4055 static int
4056 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
4057 {
4058 if (type == NULL)
4059 return 0;
4060 else
4061 {
4062 switch (type->code ())
4063 {
4064 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4065 return 1;
4066 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4067 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
4068 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
4069 default:
4070 return 0;
4071 }
4072 }
4073 }
4074
4075 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
4076
4077 static int
4078 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
4079 {
4080 if (type == NULL)
4081 return 0;
4082 else
4083 {
4084 switch (type->code ())
4085 {
4086 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4087 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4088 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4089 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
4090 return 1;
4091 default:
4092 return 0;
4093 }
4094 }
4095 }
4096
4097 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
4098
4099 static int
4100 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
4101 {
4102 if (type == NULL)
4103 return 0;
4104 else
4105 {
4106 switch (type->code ())
4107 {
4108 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4109 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4110 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4111 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
4112 return 1;
4113 default:
4114 return 0;
4115 }
4116 }
4117 }
4118
4119 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
4120 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
4121 (i.e., result 0). */
4122
4123 static int
4124 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
4125 {
4126 struct type *type0 =
4127 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
4128 struct type *type1 =
4129 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
4130
4131 if (type0 == NULL)
4132 return 0;
4133
4134 switch (op)
4135 {
4136 default:
4137 return 0;
4138
4139 case BINOP_ADD:
4140 case BINOP_SUB:
4141 case BINOP_MUL:
4142 case BINOP_DIV:
4143 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
4144
4145 case BINOP_REM:
4146 case BINOP_MOD:
4147 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
4148 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
4149 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
4150 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4151
4152 case BINOP_EQUAL:
4153 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
4154 case BINOP_LESS:
4155 case BINOP_GTR:
4156 case BINOP_LEQ:
4157 case BINOP_GEQ:
4158 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
4159
4160 case BINOP_CONCAT:
4161 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
4162
4163 case BINOP_EXP:
4164 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4165
4166 case UNOP_NEG:
4167 case UNOP_PLUS:
4168 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
4169 case UNOP_ABS:
4170 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
4171
4172 }
4173 }
4174 \f
4175 /* Renaming */
4176
4177 /* NOTES:
4178
4179 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
4180 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
4181 point.
4182 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
4183 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
4184 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
4185 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
4186 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
4187 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
4188
4189 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
4190
4191 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
4192
4193 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
4194 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
4195 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
4196 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
4197 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
4198 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
4199 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
4200 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
4201 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
4202 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
4203 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
4204 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
4205
4206 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
4207
4208 enum ada_renaming_category
4209 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
4210 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
4211 const char **renaming_expr)
4212 {
4213 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
4214 const char *info;
4215 const char *suffix;
4216
4217 if (sym == NULL)
4218 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4219 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4220 {
4221 default:
4222 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4223 case LOC_LOCAL:
4224 case LOC_STATIC:
4225 case LOC_COMPUTED:
4226 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
4227 info = strstr (sym->linkage_name (), "___XR");
4228 if (info == NULL)
4229 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4230 switch (info[5])
4231 {
4232 case '_':
4233 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
4234 info += 6;
4235 break;
4236 case 'E':
4237 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
4238 info += 7;
4239 break;
4240 case 'P':
4241 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
4242 info += 7;
4243 break;
4244 case 'S':
4245 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
4246 info += 7;
4247 break;
4248 default:
4249 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4250 }
4251 }
4252
4253 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4254 *renamed_entity = info;
4255 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4256 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4257 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4258 if (len != NULL)
4259 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
4260 suffix += 5;
4261 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4262 *renaming_expr = suffix;
4263 return kind;
4264 }
4265
4266 /* Compute the value of the given RENAMING_SYM, which is expected to
4267 be a symbol encoding a renaming expression. BLOCK is the block
4268 used to evaluate the renaming. */
4269
4270 static struct value *
4271 ada_read_renaming_var_value (struct symbol *renaming_sym,
4272 const struct block *block)
4273 {
4274 const char *sym_name;
4275
4276 sym_name = renaming_sym->linkage_name ();
4277 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&sym_name, 0, block, 0);
4278 return evaluate_expression (expr.get ());
4279 }
4280 \f
4281
4282 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
4283
4284 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
4285 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory
4286 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */
4287
4288 static struct value *
4289 ensure_lval (struct value *val)
4290 {
4291 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval
4292 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar)
4293 {
4294 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
4295 const CORE_ADDR addr =
4296 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len));
4297
4298 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
4299 set_value_address (val, addr);
4300 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len);
4301 }
4302
4303 return val;
4304 }
4305
4306 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
4307 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
4308 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
4309 appropriate type.
4310
4311 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
4312 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
4313 (e.g., '_parent').
4314
4315 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
4316 calling error. */
4317
4318 static struct value *
4319 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, const char *name, int no_err)
4320 {
4321 struct type *t, *t1;
4322 struct value *v;
4323 int check_tag;
4324
4325 v = NULL;
4326 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
4327 if (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4328 {
4329 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
4330 if (t1 == NULL)
4331 goto BadValue;
4332 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
4333 if (t1->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4334 {
4335 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
4336 t = t1;
4337 }
4338 }
4339
4340 while (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4341 {
4342 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
4343 if (t1 == NULL)
4344 goto BadValue;
4345 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
4346 if (t1->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4347 {
4348 arg = value_ind (arg);
4349 t = t1;
4350 }
4351 else
4352 break;
4353 }
4354
4355 if (t1->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && t1->code () != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
4356 goto BadValue;
4357
4358 if (t1 == t)
4359 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
4360 else
4361 {
4362 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
4363 struct type *field_type;
4364 CORE_ADDR address;
4365
4366 if (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4367 address = value_address (ada_value_ind (arg));
4368 else
4369 address = value_address (ada_coerce_ref (arg));
4370
4371 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
4372 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
4373 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
4374 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
4375 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
4376
4377 if (ada_is_tagged_type (t1, 0)
4378 || (t1->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
4379 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t1), 0)))
4380 {
4381 /* We first try to find the searched field in the current type.
4382 If not found then let's look in the fixed type. */
4383
4384 if (!find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
4385 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
4386 &bit_size, NULL))
4387 check_tag = 1;
4388 else
4389 check_tag = 0;
4390 }
4391 else
4392 check_tag = 0;
4393
4394 /* Convert to fixed type in all cases, so that we have proper
4395 offsets to each field in unconstrained record types. */
4396 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL,
4397 address, NULL, check_tag);
4398
4399 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
4400 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
4401 &bit_size, NULL))
4402 {
4403 if (bit_size != 0)
4404 {
4405 if (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4406 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
4407 else
4408 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
4409 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
4410 bit_offset, bit_size,
4411 field_type);
4412 }
4413 else
4414 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
4415 }
4416 }
4417
4418 if (v != NULL || no_err)
4419 return v;
4420 else
4421 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
4422
4423 BadValue:
4424 if (no_err)
4425 return NULL;
4426 else
4427 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of "
4428 "a value that is not a record."));
4429 }
4430
4431 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
4432 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
4433 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
4434 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
4435
4436 struct value *
4437 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0)
4438 {
4439 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4440 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
4441 struct type *formal_target =
4442 formal_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4443 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
4444 struct type *actual_target =
4445 actual_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4446 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
4447
4448 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
4449 && actual_target->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
4450 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual);
4451 else if (formal_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4452 || formal_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4453 {
4454 struct value *result;
4455
4456 if (formal_target->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
4457 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
4458 result = desc_data (actual);
4459 else if (formal_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4460 {
4461 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
4462 {
4463 struct value *val;
4464
4465 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4466 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
4467 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
4468 (char *) value_contents (actual),
4469 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
4470 actual = ensure_lval (val);
4471 }
4472 result = value_addr (actual);
4473 }
4474 else
4475 return actual;
4476 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result, 0);
4477 }
4478 else if (actual_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4479 return ada_value_ind (actual);
4480 else if (ada_is_aligner_type (formal_type))
4481 {
4482 /* We need to turn this parameter into an aligner type
4483 as well. */
4484 struct value *aligner = allocate_value (formal_type);
4485 struct value *component = ada_value_struct_elt (aligner, "F", 0);
4486
4487 value_assign_to_component (aligner, component, actual);
4488 return aligner;
4489 }
4490
4491 return actual;
4492 }
4493
4494 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of
4495 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets
4496 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address
4497 differs. */
4498
4499 static CORE_ADDR
4500 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type)
4501 {
4502 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type);
4503 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
4504 gdb_byte *buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
4505 CORE_ADDR addr;
4506
4507 addr = value_address (value);
4508 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr);
4509 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, type_byte_order (type));
4510 return addr;
4511 }
4512
4513
4514 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
4515 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
4516 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
4517 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
4518 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
4519
4520 static struct value *
4521 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr)
4522 {
4523 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
4524 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
4525 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
4526 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
4527 int i;
4528
4529 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)));
4530 i > 0; i -= 1)
4531 {
4532 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4533 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
4534 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
4535 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
4536 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4537 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
4538 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
4539 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
4540 }
4541
4542 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds);
4543
4544 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4545 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4546 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr),
4547 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)),
4548 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
4549 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
4550
4551 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4552 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4553 value_pointer (bounds,
4554 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)),
4555 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
4556 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
4557
4558 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor);
4559
4560 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4561 return value_addr (descriptor);
4562 else
4563 return descriptor;
4564 }
4565 \f
4566 /* Symbol Cache Module */
4567
4568 /* Performance measurements made as of 2010-01-15 indicate that
4569 this cache does bring some noticeable improvements. Depending
4570 on the type of entity being printed, the cache can make it as much
4571 as an order of magnitude faster than without it.
4572
4573 The descriptive type DWARF extension has significantly reduced
4574 the need for this cache, at least when DWARF is being used. However,
4575 even in this case, some expensive name-based symbol searches are still
4576 sometimes necessary - to find an XVZ variable, mostly. */
4577
4578 /* Initialize the contents of SYM_CACHE. */
4579
4580 static void
4581 ada_init_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4582 {
4583 obstack_init (&sym_cache->cache_space);
4584 memset (sym_cache->root, '\000', sizeof (sym_cache->root));
4585 }
4586
4587 /* Free the memory used by SYM_CACHE. */
4588
4589 static void
4590 ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4591 {
4592 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4593 xfree (sym_cache);
4594 }
4595
4596 /* Return the symbol cache associated to the given program space PSPACE.
4597 If not allocated for this PSPACE yet, allocate and initialize one. */
4598
4599 static struct ada_symbol_cache *
4600 ada_get_symbol_cache (struct program_space *pspace)
4601 {
4602 struct ada_pspace_data *pspace_data = get_ada_pspace_data (pspace);
4603
4604 if (pspace_data->sym_cache == NULL)
4605 {
4606 pspace_data->sym_cache = XCNEW (struct ada_symbol_cache);
4607 ada_init_symbol_cache (pspace_data->sym_cache);
4608 }
4609
4610 return pspace_data->sym_cache;
4611 }
4612
4613 /* Clear all entries from the symbol cache. */
4614
4615 static void
4616 ada_clear_symbol_cache (void)
4617 {
4618 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4619 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4620
4621 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4622 ada_init_symbol_cache (sym_cache);
4623 }
4624
4625 /* Search our cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4626 Return it if found, or NULL otherwise. */
4627
4628 static struct cache_entry **
4629 find_entry (const char *name, domain_enum domain)
4630 {
4631 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4632 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4633 int h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4634 struct cache_entry **e;
4635
4636 for (e = &sym_cache->root[h]; *e != NULL; e = &(*e)->next)
4637 {
4638 if (domain == (*e)->domain && strcmp (name, (*e)->name) == 0)
4639 return e;
4640 }
4641 return NULL;
4642 }
4643
4644 /* Search the symbol cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4645 Return 1 if found, 0 otherwise.
4646
4647 If an entry was found and SYM is not NULL, set *SYM to the entry's
4648 SYM. Same principle for BLOCK if not NULL. */
4649
4650 static int
4651 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain,
4652 struct symbol **sym, const struct block **block)
4653 {
4654 struct cache_entry **e = find_entry (name, domain);
4655
4656 if (e == NULL)
4657 return 0;
4658 if (sym != NULL)
4659 *sym = (*e)->sym;
4660 if (block != NULL)
4661 *block = (*e)->block;
4662 return 1;
4663 }
4664
4665 /* Assuming that (SYM, BLOCK) is the result of the lookup of NAME
4666 in domain DOMAIN, save this result in our symbol cache. */
4667
4668 static void
4669 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain, struct symbol *sym,
4670 const struct block *block)
4671 {
4672 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4673 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4674 int h;
4675 struct cache_entry *e;
4676
4677 /* Symbols for builtin types don't have a block.
4678 For now don't cache such symbols. */
4679 if (sym != NULL && !SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (sym))
4680 return;
4681
4682 /* If the symbol is a local symbol, then do not cache it, as a search
4683 for that symbol depends on the context. To determine whether
4684 the symbol is local or not, we check the block where we found it
4685 against the global and static blocks of its associated symtab. */
4686 if (sym
4687 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4688 GLOBAL_BLOCK) != block
4689 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4690 STATIC_BLOCK) != block)
4691 return;
4692
4693 h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4694 e = XOBNEW (&sym_cache->cache_space, cache_entry);
4695 e->next = sym_cache->root[h];
4696 sym_cache->root[h] = e;
4697 e->name = obstack_strdup (&sym_cache->cache_space, name);
4698 e->sym = sym;
4699 e->domain = domain;
4700 e->block = block;
4701 }
4702 \f
4703 /* Symbol Lookup */
4704
4705 /* Return the symbol name match type that should be used used when
4706 searching for all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME.
4707
4708 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation
4709 for Ada lookups. */
4710
4711 static symbol_name_match_type
4712 name_match_type_from_name (const char *lookup_name)
4713 {
4714 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL
4715 ? symbol_name_match_type::WILD
4716 : symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
4717 }
4718
4719 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
4720 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
4721
4722 static struct symbol *
4723 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
4724 domain_enum domain)
4725 {
4726 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
4727 struct block_symbol sym = {};
4728
4729 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym.symbol, NULL))
4730 return sym.symbol;
4731 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (name, block, domain, &sym);
4732 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym.symbol, sym.block);
4733 return sym.symbol;
4734 }
4735
4736
4737 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4738 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4739 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4740 static int
4741 is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol syms[], int n)
4742 {
4743 int i;
4744
4745 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4746 if (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4747 && (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4748 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) != LOC_CONST))
4749 return 1;
4750
4751 return 0;
4752 }
4753
4754 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4755 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4756
4757 static int
4758 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4759 {
4760 if (type0 == type1)
4761 return 1;
4762 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4763 || type0->code () != type1->code ())
4764 return 0;
4765 if ((type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4766 || type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4767 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4768 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4769 return 1;
4770
4771 return 0;
4772 }
4773
4774 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4775 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4776
4777 static int
4778 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4779 {
4780 if (sym0 == sym1)
4781 return 1;
4782 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4783 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4784 return 0;
4785
4786 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4787 {
4788 case LOC_UNDEF:
4789 return 1;
4790 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4791 {
4792 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4793 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4794 const char *name0 = sym0->linkage_name ();
4795 const char *name1 = sym1->linkage_name ();
4796 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4797
4798 return
4799 type0->code () == type1->code ()
4800 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4801 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4802 && startswith (name1 + len0, "___XV")));
4803 }
4804 case LOC_CONST:
4805 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4806 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4807
4808 case LOC_STATIC:
4809 {
4810 const char *name0 = sym0->linkage_name ();
4811 const char *name1 = sym1->linkage_name ();
4812 return (strcmp (name0, name1) == 0
4813 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym1));
4814 }
4815
4816 default:
4817 return 0;
4818 }
4819 }
4820
4821 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct block_symbol
4822 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4823
4824 static void
4825 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4826 struct symbol *sym,
4827 const struct block *block)
4828 {
4829 int i;
4830 struct block_symbol *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4831
4832 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4833 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4834 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4835 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4836 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4837 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4838 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4839 out the stub ones if needed. */
4840
4841 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4842 {
4843 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].symbol))
4844 return;
4845 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].symbol, sym))
4846 {
4847 prevDefns[i].symbol = sym;
4848 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4849 return;
4850 }
4851 }
4852
4853 {
4854 struct block_symbol info;
4855
4856 info.symbol = sym;
4857 info.block = block;
4858 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct block_symbol));
4859 }
4860 }
4861
4862 /* Number of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in
4863 OBSTACKP. */
4864
4865 static int
4866 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4867 {
4868 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct block_symbol);
4869 }
4870
4871 /* Vector of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in
4872 OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return its final address. */
4873
4874 static struct block_symbol *
4875 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4876 {
4877 if (finish)
4878 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_finish (obstackp);
4879 else
4880 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4881 }
4882
4883 /* Return a bound minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada
4884 decoding rules. Returns an invalid symbol if there is no such
4885 minimal symbol. Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled
4886 specially: "standard__" is first stripped off, and only static and
4887 global symbols are searched. */
4888
4889 struct bound_minimal_symbol
4890 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4891 {
4892 struct bound_minimal_symbol result;
4893
4894 memset (&result, 0, sizeof (result));
4895
4896 symbol_name_match_type match_type = name_match_type_from_name (name);
4897 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, match_type);
4898
4899 symbol_name_matcher_ftype *match_name
4900 = ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (lookup_name);
4901
4902 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
4903 {
4904 for (minimal_symbol *msymbol : objfile->msymbols ())
4905 {
4906 if (match_name (msymbol->linkage_name (), lookup_name, NULL)
4907 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4908 {
4909 result.minsym = msymbol;
4910 result.objfile = objfile;
4911 break;
4912 }
4913 }
4914 }
4915
4916 return result;
4917 }
4918
4919 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4920 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4921 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4922 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD_MATCH_P, treat as NAME
4923 with a wildcard prefix. */
4924
4925 static void
4926 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4927 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
4928 domain_enum domain)
4929 {
4930 }
4931
4932 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4933 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4934
4935 static int
4936 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4937 {
4938 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4939
4940 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4941 }
4942
4943 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types
4944 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes.
4945
4946 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4947 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other
4948 words, type1->num_fields () == type2->num_fields ()). */
4949
4950 static int
4951 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2)
4952 {
4953 int i;
4954
4955 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider
4956 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same
4957 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same
4958 underlying value and name. */
4959
4960 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */
4961 for (i = 0; i < type1->num_fields (); i++)
4962 if (TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type2, i))
4963 return 0;
4964
4965 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical
4966 suffix). */
4967 for (i = 0; i < type1->num_fields (); i++)
4968 {
4969 const char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i);
4970 const char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i);
4971 int len_1 = strlen (name_1);
4972 int len_2 = strlen (name_2);
4973
4974 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1);
4975 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2);
4976 if (len_1 != len_2
4977 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i),
4978 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i),
4979 len_1) != 0)
4980 return 0;
4981 }
4982
4983 return 1;
4984 }
4985
4986 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols
4987 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes,
4988 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar
4989 that they can be considered identical.
4990
4991 For instance, consider the following code:
4992
4993 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White);
4994 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue;
4995
4996 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy
4997 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is
4998 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color.
4999 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral
5000 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically
5001 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But
5002 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter
5003 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same.
5004 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */
5005
5006 static int
5007 symbols_are_identical_enums (const std::vector<struct block_symbol> &syms)
5008 {
5009 int i;
5010
5011 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type,
5012 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these
5013 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus
5014 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison.
5015 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks
5016 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */
5017
5018 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */
5019 for (i = 0; i < syms.size (); i++)
5020 if (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
5021 return 0;
5022
5023 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */
5024 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5025 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].symbol) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].symbol))
5026 return 0;
5027
5028 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */
5029 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5030 if (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->num_fields ()
5031 != SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol)->num_fields ())
5032 return 0;
5033
5034 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of
5035 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete
5036 comparison of the type of each symbol. */
5037 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5038 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol),
5039 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol)))
5040 return 0;
5041
5042 return 1;
5043 }
5044
5045 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS that definitely
5046 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
5047 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
5048 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
5049 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
5050 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
5051
5052 static int
5053 remove_extra_symbols (std::vector<struct block_symbol> *syms)
5054 {
5055 int i, j;
5056
5057 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there
5058 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to
5059 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */
5060 if (syms->size () < 2)
5061 return syms->size ();
5062
5063 i = 0;
5064 while (i < syms->size ())
5065 {
5066 int remove_p = 0;
5067
5068 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
5069 the get rid of the stub. */
5070
5071 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[i].symbol))
5072 && (*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL)
5073 {
5074 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j++)
5075 {
5076 if (j != i
5077 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[j].symbol))
5078 && (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5079 && strcmp ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name (),
5080 (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name ()) == 0)
5081 remove_p = 1;
5082 }
5083 }
5084
5085 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
5086 should be identical. */
5087
5088 else if ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5089 && SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[i].symbol) == LOC_STATIC
5090 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[i].symbol)))
5091 {
5092 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5093 {
5094 if (i != j
5095 && (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5096 && strcmp ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name (),
5097 (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name ()) == 0
5098 && SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[i].symbol)
5099 == SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[j].symbol)
5100 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS ((*syms)[i].symbol)
5101 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS ((*syms)[j].symbol))
5102 remove_p = 1;
5103 }
5104 }
5105
5106 if (remove_p)
5107 syms->erase (syms->begin () + i);
5108
5109 i += 1;
5110 }
5111
5112 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then
5113 just keep the first one and discard the rest.
5114
5115 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry
5116 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol
5117 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical
5118 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then
5119 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest.
5120 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have
5121 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to
5122 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list
5123 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */
5124 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (*syms))
5125 syms->resize (1);
5126
5127 return syms->size ();
5128 }
5129
5130 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
5131 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
5132 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
5133 defined. */
5134
5135 static std::string
5136 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
5137 {
5138 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
5139 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
5140 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
5141 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
5142
5143 const char *name = renaming_type->name ();
5144 const char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5145 const char *last;
5146
5147 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
5148 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
5149
5150 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
5151 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
5152 break;
5153
5154 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
5155 return std::string (name, last);
5156 }
5157
5158 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
5159
5160 static int
5161 is_package_name (const char *name)
5162 {
5163 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
5164 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
5165 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
5166 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
5167 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
5168
5169 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
5170 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
5171 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
5172 return 0;
5173
5174 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
5175 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
5176
5177 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
5178 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
5179 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
5180 return 0;
5181
5182 std::string fun_name = string_printf ("_ada_%s", name);
5183
5184 return (standard_lookup (fun_name.c_str (), NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
5185 }
5186
5187 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
5188 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
5189
5190 static int
5191 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, const char *function_name)
5192 {
5193 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
5194 return 0;
5195
5196 std::string scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
5197
5198 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
5199 if (is_package_name (scope.c_str ()))
5200 return 0;
5201
5202 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
5203 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
5204
5205 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
5206 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
5207 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
5208 this prefix. */
5209 if (startswith (function_name, "_ada_"))
5210 function_name += 5;
5211
5212 return !startswith (function_name, scope.c_str ());
5213 }
5214
5215 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
5216 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
5217 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
5218 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
5219 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
5220
5221 Rationale:
5222 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
5223 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
5224 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
5225 latter.
5226
5227 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
5228 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
5229 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
5230 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
5231 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
5232 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
5233 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
5234
5235 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
5236 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
5237 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
5238 method with the current information available. The implementation
5239 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
5240
5241 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
5242 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
5243 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
5244 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
5245 currently not the case.
5246
5247 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
5248 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
5249 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
5250 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
5251
5252 static int
5253 remove_irrelevant_renamings (std::vector<struct block_symbol> *syms,
5254 const struct block *current_block)
5255 {
5256 struct symbol *current_function;
5257 const char *current_function_name;
5258 int i;
5259 int is_new_style_renaming;
5260
5261 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
5262 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
5263 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
5264 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
5265 for (i = 0; i < syms->size (); i += 1)
5266 {
5267 struct symbol *sym = (*syms)[i].symbol;
5268 const struct block *block = (*syms)[i].block;
5269 const char *name;
5270 const char *suffix;
5271
5272 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
5273 continue;
5274 name = sym->linkage_name ();
5275 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5276
5277 if (suffix != NULL)
5278 {
5279 int name_len = suffix - name;
5280 int j;
5281
5282 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
5283 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5284 if (i != j && (*syms)[j].symbol != NULL
5285 && strncmp (name, (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name (),
5286 name_len) == 0
5287 && block == (*syms)[j].block)
5288 (*syms)[j].symbol = NULL;
5289 }
5290 }
5291 if (is_new_style_renaming)
5292 {
5293 int j, k;
5294
5295 for (j = k = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5296 if ((*syms)[j].symbol != NULL)
5297 {
5298 (*syms)[k] = (*syms)[j];
5299 k += 1;
5300 }
5301 return k;
5302 }
5303
5304 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
5305 Abort if unable to do so. */
5306
5307 if (current_block == NULL)
5308 return syms->size ();
5309
5310 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
5311 if (current_function == NULL)
5312 return syms->size ();
5313
5314 current_function_name = current_function->linkage_name ();
5315 if (current_function_name == NULL)
5316 return syms->size ();
5317
5318 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
5319 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
5320 the current block. */
5321
5322 i = 0;
5323 while (i < syms->size ())
5324 {
5325 if (ada_parse_renaming ((*syms)[i].symbol, NULL, NULL, NULL)
5326 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
5327 && old_renaming_is_invisible ((*syms)[i].symbol,
5328 current_function_name))
5329 syms->erase (syms->begin () + i);
5330 else
5331 i += 1;
5332 }
5333
5334 return syms->size ();
5335 }
5336
5337 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
5338 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
5339 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
5340 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
5341 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
5342 If WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in
5343 "wild" mode (see function "wild_match" for more info).
5344
5345 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
5346
5347 static void
5348 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5349 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5350 const struct block *block, domain_enum domain)
5351 {
5352 int block_depth = 0;
5353
5354 while (block != NULL)
5355 {
5356 block_depth += 1;
5357 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain, NULL);
5358
5359 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
5360 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
5361 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
5362 return;
5363
5364 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
5365 }
5366
5367 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
5368 enclosing subprogram. */
5369 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
5370 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, lookup_name, domain);
5371 }
5372
5373 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when
5374 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */
5375
5376 struct match_data
5377 {
5378 struct objfile *objfile;
5379 struct obstack *obstackp;
5380 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5381 int found_sym;
5382 };
5383
5384 /* A callback for add_nonlocal_symbols that adds symbol, found in BSYM,
5385 to a list of symbols. DATA is a pointer to a struct match_data *
5386 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM
5387 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has
5388 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol
5389 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null,
5390 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no
5391 other has been found. */
5392
5393 static bool
5394 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block_symbol *bsym,
5395 struct match_data *data)
5396 {
5397 const struct block *block = bsym->block;
5398 struct symbol *sym = bsym->symbol;
5399
5400 if (sym == NULL)
5401 {
5402 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL)
5403 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5404 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile),
5405 block);
5406 data->found_sym = 0;
5407 data->arg_sym = NULL;
5408 }
5409 else
5410 {
5411 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5412 return true;
5413 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5414 data->arg_sym = sym;
5415 else
5416 {
5417 data->found_sym = 1;
5418 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5419 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile),
5420 block);
5421 }
5422 }
5423 return true;
5424 }
5425
5426 /* Helper for add_nonlocal_symbols. Find symbols in DOMAIN which are
5427 targeted by renamings matching LOOKUP_NAME in BLOCK. Add these
5428 symbols to OBSTACKP. Return whether we found such symbols. */
5429
5430 static int
5431 ada_add_block_renamings (struct obstack *obstackp,
5432 const struct block *block,
5433 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5434 domain_enum domain)
5435 {
5436 struct using_direct *renaming;
5437 int defns_mark = num_defns_collected (obstackp);
5438
5439 symbol_name_matcher_ftype *name_match
5440 = ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (lookup_name);
5441
5442 for (renaming = block_using (block);
5443 renaming != NULL;
5444 renaming = renaming->next)
5445 {
5446 const char *r_name;
5447
5448 /* Avoid infinite recursions: skip this renaming if we are actually
5449 already traversing it.
5450
5451 Currently, symbol lookup in Ada don't use the namespace machinery from
5452 C++/Fortran support: skip namespace imports that use them. */
5453 if (renaming->searched
5454 || (renaming->import_src != NULL
5455 && renaming->import_src[0] != '\0')
5456 || (renaming->import_dest != NULL
5457 && renaming->import_dest[0] != '\0'))
5458 continue;
5459 renaming->searched = 1;
5460
5461 /* TODO: here, we perform another name-based symbol lookup, which can
5462 pull its own multiple overloads. In theory, we should be able to do
5463 better in this case since, in DWARF, DW_AT_import is a DIE reference,
5464 not a simple name. But in order to do this, we would need to enhance
5465 the DWARF reader to associate a symbol to this renaming, instead of a
5466 name. So, for now, we do something simpler: re-use the C++/Fortran
5467 namespace machinery. */
5468 r_name = (renaming->alias != NULL
5469 ? renaming->alias
5470 : renaming->declaration);
5471 if (name_match (r_name, lookup_name, NULL))
5472 {
5473 lookup_name_info decl_lookup_name (renaming->declaration,
5474 lookup_name.match_type ());
5475 ada_add_all_symbols (obstackp, block, decl_lookup_name, domain,
5476 1, NULL);
5477 }
5478 renaming->searched = 0;
5479 }
5480 return num_defns_collected (obstackp) != defns_mark;
5481 }
5482
5483 /* Implements compare_names, but only applying the comparision using
5484 the given CASING. */
5485
5486 static int
5487 compare_names_with_case (const char *string1, const char *string2,
5488 enum case_sensitivity casing)
5489 {
5490 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0')
5491 {
5492 char c1, c2;
5493
5494 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2))
5495 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5496
5497 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5498 {
5499 c1 = tolower (*string1);
5500 c2 = tolower (*string2);
5501 }
5502 else
5503 {
5504 c1 = *string1;
5505 c2 = *string2;
5506 }
5507 if (c1 != c2)
5508 break;
5509
5510 string1 += 1;
5511 string2 += 1;
5512 }
5513
5514 switch (*string1)
5515 {
5516 case '(':
5517 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5518 case '_':
5519 if (*string2 == '\0')
5520 {
5521 if (is_name_suffix (string1))
5522 return 0;
5523 else
5524 return 1;
5525 }
5526 /* FALLTHROUGH */
5527 default:
5528 if (*string2 == '(')
5529 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5530 else
5531 {
5532 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5533 return tolower (*string1) - tolower (*string2);
5534 else
5535 return *string1 - *string2;
5536 }
5537 }
5538 }
5539
5540 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp.
5541 Compatible with strcmp_iw_ordered in that...
5542
5543 strcmp_iw_ordered (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5544
5545 ... implies...
5546
5547 compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5548
5549 (they may differ as to what symbols compare equal). */
5550
5551 static int
5552 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2)
5553 {
5554 int result;
5555
5556 /* Similar to what strcmp_iw_ordered does, we need to perform
5557 a case-insensitive comparison first, and only resort to
5558 a second, case-sensitive, comparison if the first one was
5559 not sufficient to differentiate the two strings. */
5560
5561 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_off);
5562 if (result == 0)
5563 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_on);
5564
5565 return result;
5566 }
5567
5568 /* Convenience function to get at the Ada encoded lookup name for
5569 LOOKUP_NAME, as a C string. */
5570
5571 static const char *
5572 ada_lookup_name (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
5573 {
5574 return lookup_name.ada ().lookup_name ().c_str ();
5575 }
5576
5577 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
5578 LOOKUP_NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on
5579 GLOBAL_BLOCK symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK
5580 symbols otherwise. */
5581
5582 static void
5583 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5584 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5585 domain_enum domain, int global)
5586 {
5587 struct match_data data;
5588
5589 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data);
5590 data.obstackp = obstackp;
5591
5592 bool is_wild_match = lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ();
5593
5594 auto callback = [&] (struct block_symbol *bsym)
5595 {
5596 return aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (bsym, &data);
5597 };
5598
5599 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
5600 {
5601 data.objfile = objfile;
5602
5603 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, lookup_name,
5604 domain, global, callback,
5605 (is_wild_match
5606 ? NULL : compare_names));
5607
5608 for (compunit_symtab *cu : objfile->compunits ())
5609 {
5610 const struct block *global_block
5611 = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (cu), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5612
5613 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, global_block, lookup_name,
5614 domain))
5615 data.found_sym = 1;
5616 }
5617 }
5618
5619 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match)
5620 {
5621 const char *name = ada_lookup_name (lookup_name);
5622 std::string bracket_name = std::string ("<_ada_") + name + '>';
5623 lookup_name_info name1 (bracket_name, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
5624
5625 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
5626 {
5627 data.objfile = objfile;
5628 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name1,
5629 domain, global, callback,
5630 compare_names);
5631 }
5632 }
5633 }
5634
5635 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching LOOKUP_NAME, in BLOCK and, if
5636 FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes,
5637 returning the number of matches. Add these to OBSTACKP.
5638
5639 When FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5640 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK,
5641 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5642 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5643 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned.
5644
5645 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially:
5646 "standard__" is first stripped off (by the lookup_name
5647 constructor), and only static and global symbols are searched.
5648
5649 If MADE_GLOBAL_LOOKUP_P is non-null, set it before return to whether we had
5650 to lookup global symbols. */
5651
5652 static void
5653 ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5654 const struct block *block,
5655 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5656 domain_enum domain,
5657 int full_search,
5658 int *made_global_lookup_p)
5659 {
5660 struct symbol *sym;
5661
5662 if (made_global_lookup_p)
5663 *made_global_lookup_p = 0;
5664
5665 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
5666 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
5667 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
5668 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
5669 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
5670 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
5671 entity inside its program). */
5672 if (lookup_name.ada ().standard_p ())
5673 block = NULL;
5674
5675 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
5676
5677 if (block != NULL)
5678 {
5679 if (full_search)
5680 ada_add_local_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, block, domain);
5681 else
5682 {
5683 /* In the !full_search case we're are being called by
5684 iterate_over_symbols, and we don't want to search
5685 superblocks. */
5686 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain, NULL);
5687 }
5688 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) > 0 || !full_search)
5689 return;
5690 }
5691
5692 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
5693 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
5694 the same result. */
5695
5696 if (lookup_cached_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name),
5697 domain, &sym, &block))
5698 {
5699 if (sym != NULL)
5700 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, sym, block);
5701 return;
5702 }
5703
5704 if (made_global_lookup_p)
5705 *made_global_lookup_p = 1;
5706
5707 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
5708
5709 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, domain, 1);
5710
5711 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
5712 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
5713
5714 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0)
5715 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, domain, 0);
5716 }
5717
5718 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching LOOKUP_NAME, in BLOCK and, if FULL_SEARCH
5719 is non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes, returning the number of
5720 matches.
5721 Fills *RESULTS with (SYM,BLOCK) tuples, indicating the symbols
5722 found and the blocks and symbol tables (if any) in which they were
5723 found.
5724
5725 When full_search is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5726 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK,
5727 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5728 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5729 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned.
5730
5731 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
5732 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
5733
5734 static int
5735 ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5736 const struct block *block,
5737 domain_enum domain,
5738 std::vector<struct block_symbol> *results,
5739 int full_search)
5740 {
5741 int syms_from_global_search;
5742 int ndefns;
5743 auto_obstack obstack;
5744
5745 ada_add_all_symbols (&obstack, block, lookup_name,
5746 domain, full_search, &syms_from_global_search);
5747
5748 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&obstack);
5749
5750 struct block_symbol *base = defns_collected (&obstack, 1);
5751 for (int i = 0; i < ndefns; ++i)
5752 results->push_back (base[i]);
5753
5754 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (results);
5755
5756 if (ndefns == 0 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5757 cache_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name), domain, NULL, NULL);
5758
5759 if (ndefns == 1 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5760 cache_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name), domain,
5761 (*results)[0].symbol, (*results)[0].block);
5762
5763 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (results, block);
5764
5765 return ndefns;
5766 }
5767
5768 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK and enclosing scope and
5769 in global scopes, returning the number of matches, and filling *RESULTS
5770 with (SYM,BLOCK) tuples.
5771
5772 See ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker for further details. */
5773
5774 int
5775 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5776 domain_enum domain,
5777 std::vector<struct block_symbol> *results)
5778 {
5779 symbol_name_match_type name_match_type = name_match_type_from_name (name);
5780 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, name_match_type);
5781
5782 return ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (lookup_name, block, domain, results, 1);
5783 }
5784
5785 /* The result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list with FULL_SEARCH set
5786 to 1, but choosing the first symbol found if there are multiple
5787 choices.
5788
5789 The result is stored in *INFO, which must be non-NULL.
5790 If no match is found, INFO->SYM is set to NULL. */
5791
5792 void
5793 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5794 domain_enum domain,
5795 struct block_symbol *info)
5796 {
5797 /* Since we already have an encoded name, wrap it in '<>' to force a
5798 verbatim match. Otherwise, if the name happens to not look like
5799 an encoded name (because it doesn't include a "__"),
5800 ada_lookup_name_info would re-encode/fold it again, and that
5801 would e.g., incorrectly lowercase object renaming names like
5802 "R28b" -> "r28b". */
5803 std::string verbatim = std::string ("<") + name + '>';
5804
5805 gdb_assert (info != NULL);
5806 *info = ada_lookup_symbol (verbatim.c_str (), block, domain);
5807 }
5808
5809 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5810 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
5811 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
5812 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices. */
5813
5814 struct block_symbol
5815 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5816 domain_enum domain)
5817 {
5818 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
5819 int n_candidates;
5820
5821 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, domain, &candidates);
5822
5823 if (n_candidates == 0)
5824 return {};
5825
5826 block_symbol info = candidates[0];
5827 info.symbol = fixup_symbol_section (info.symbol, NULL);
5828 return info;
5829 }
5830
5831 static struct block_symbol
5832 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const struct language_defn *langdef,
5833 const char *name,
5834 const struct block *block,
5835 const domain_enum domain)
5836 {
5837 struct block_symbol sym;
5838
5839 sym = ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain);
5840 if (sym.symbol != NULL)
5841 return sym;
5842
5843 /* If we haven't found a match at this point, try the primitive
5844 types. In other languages, this search is performed before
5845 searching for global symbols in order to short-circuit that
5846 global-symbol search if it happens that the name corresponds
5847 to a primitive type. But we cannot do the same in Ada, because
5848 it is perfectly legitimate for a program to declare a type which
5849 has the same name as a standard type. If looking up a type in
5850 that situation, we have traditionally ignored the primitive type
5851 in favor of user-defined types. This is why, unlike most other
5852 languages, we search the primitive types this late and only after
5853 having searched the global symbols without success. */
5854
5855 if (domain == VAR_DOMAIN)
5856 {
5857 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5858
5859 if (block == NULL)
5860 gdbarch = target_gdbarch ();
5861 else
5862 gdbarch = block_gdbarch (block);
5863 sym.symbol = language_lookup_primitive_type_as_symbol (langdef, gdbarch, name);
5864 if (sym.symbol != NULL)
5865 return sym;
5866 }
5867
5868 return {};
5869 }
5870
5871
5872 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
5873 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
5874 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
5875 are given by any of the regular expressions:
5876
5877 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
5878 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
5879 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies]
5880 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
5881 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
5882
5883 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
5884 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
5885 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
5886
5887 static int
5888 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
5889 {
5890 int k;
5891 const char *matching;
5892 const int len = strlen (str);
5893
5894 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
5895
5896 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
5897 {
5898 str += 3;
5899 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5900 str += 1;
5901 }
5902
5903 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
5904
5905 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
5906 {
5907 matching = str + 1;
5908 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5909 matching += 1;
5910 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5911 return 1;
5912 }
5913
5914 /* ___[0-9]+ */
5915
5916 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
5917 {
5918 matching = str + 3;
5919 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5920 matching += 1;
5921 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5922 return 1;
5923 }
5924
5925 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */
5926
5927 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0)
5928 return 1;
5929
5930 #if 0
5931 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
5932 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
5933 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
5934 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
5935 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
5936 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
5937 name ends with N.
5938 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
5939 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
5940 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
5941 the following check. */
5942 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
5943 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
5944 return 1;
5945 #endif
5946
5947 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
5948 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
5949 {
5950 matching = str + 3;
5951 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5952 matching += 1;
5953 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
5954 && matching [1] == '\0')
5955 return 1;
5956 }
5957
5958 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
5959 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
5960 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
5961 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
5962 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
5963 if (str[0] == 'X')
5964 {
5965 str += 1;
5966 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
5967 {
5968 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
5969 return 0;
5970 str += 1;
5971 }
5972 }
5973
5974 if (str[0] == '\000')
5975 return 1;
5976
5977 if (str[0] == '_')
5978 {
5979 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
5980 return 0;
5981 if (str[2] == '_')
5982 {
5983 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
5984 return 1;
5985 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
5986 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
5987 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
5988 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
5989 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
5990 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
5991 return 1;
5992 if (str[3] != 'X')
5993 return 0;
5994 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
5995 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
5996 return 1;
5997 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
5998 return 1;
5999 return 0;
6000 }
6001 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
6002 return 0;
6003 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
6004 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
6005 return 0;
6006 return 1;
6007 }
6008 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
6009 {
6010 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
6011 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
6012 return 0;
6013 return 1;
6014 }
6015 return 0;
6016 }
6017
6018 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
6019 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
6020
6021 static int
6022 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
6023 {
6024 std::string decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
6025 int i;
6026
6027 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
6028 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
6029 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
6030 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
6031 return 0;
6032
6033 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
6034 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
6035 return 0;
6036
6037 return 1;
6038 }
6039
6040 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0
6041 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into
6042 the string beginning at NAME0. */
6043
6044 static int
6045 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0)
6046 {
6047 const char *name = *namep;
6048
6049 while (1)
6050 {
6051 int t0, t1;
6052
6053 t0 = *name;
6054 if (t0 == '_')
6055 {
6056 t1 = name[1];
6057 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9'))
6058 {
6059 name += 1;
6060 if (name == name0 + 5 && startswith (name0, "_ada"))
6061 break;
6062 else
6063 name += 1;
6064 }
6065 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z')
6066 || name[2] == target0))
6067 {
6068 name += 2;
6069 break;
6070 }
6071 else
6072 return 0;
6073 }
6074 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9'))
6075 name += 1;
6076 else
6077 return 0;
6078 }
6079
6080 *namep = name;
6081 return 1;
6082 }
6083
6084 /* Return true iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN.
6085 Ignores any informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which
6086 is_name_suffix is true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada
6087 simple name. */
6088
6089 static bool
6090 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn)
6091 {
6092 const char *p;
6093 const char *name0 = name;
6094
6095 while (1)
6096 {
6097 const char *match = name;
6098
6099 if (*name == *patn)
6100 {
6101 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1)
6102 if (*p != *name)
6103 break;
6104 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name))
6105 return match == name0 || is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0);
6106
6107 if (name[-1] == '_')
6108 name -= 1;
6109 }
6110 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn))
6111 return false;
6112 }
6113 }
6114
6115 /* Returns true iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, ignoring
6116 any trailing suffixes that encode debugging information or leading
6117 _ada_ on SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
6118 information that is ignored). */
6119
6120 static bool
6121 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name)
6122 {
6123 size_t search_name_len = strlen (search_name);
6124
6125 if (strncmp (sym_name, search_name, search_name_len) == 0
6126 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + search_name_len))
6127 return true;
6128
6129 if (startswith (sym_name, "_ada_")
6130 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, search_name, search_name_len) == 0
6131 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + search_name_len + 5))
6132 return true;
6133
6134 return false;
6135 }
6136
6137 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching LOOKUP_NAME in DOMAIN to vector
6138 *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP (if
6139 necessary). OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK. */
6140
6141 static void
6142 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
6143 const struct block *block,
6144 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
6145 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile)
6146 {
6147 struct block_iterator iter;
6148 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
6149 struct symbol *arg_sym;
6150 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
6151 int found_sym;
6152 struct symbol *sym;
6153
6154 arg_sym = NULL;
6155 found_sym = 0;
6156 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, lookup_name, &iter);
6157 sym != NULL;
6158 sym = block_iter_match_next (lookup_name, &iter))
6159 {
6160 if (symbol_matches_domain (sym->language (), SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6161 {
6162 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6163 {
6164 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6165 arg_sym = sym;
6166 else
6167 {
6168 found_sym = 1;
6169 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6170 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6171 block);
6172 }
6173 }
6174 }
6175 }
6176
6177 /* Handle renamings. */
6178
6179 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain))
6180 found_sym = 1;
6181
6182 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6183 {
6184 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6185 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6186 block);
6187 }
6188
6189 if (!lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ())
6190 {
6191 arg_sym = NULL;
6192 found_sym = 0;
6193 const std::string &ada_lookup_name = lookup_name.ada ().lookup_name ();
6194 const char *name = ada_lookup_name.c_str ();
6195 size_t name_len = ada_lookup_name.size ();
6196
6197 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
6198 {
6199 if (symbol_matches_domain (sym->language (),
6200 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6201 {
6202 int cmp;
6203
6204 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) sym->linkage_name ()[0];
6205 if (cmp == 0)
6206 {
6207 cmp = !startswith (sym->linkage_name (), "_ada_");
6208 if (cmp == 0)
6209 cmp = strncmp (name, sym->linkage_name () + 5,
6210 name_len);
6211 }
6212
6213 if (cmp == 0
6214 && is_name_suffix (sym->linkage_name () + name_len + 5))
6215 {
6216 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6217 {
6218 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6219 arg_sym = sym;
6220 else
6221 {
6222 found_sym = 1;
6223 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6224 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6225 block);
6226 }
6227 }
6228 }
6229 }
6230 }
6231
6232 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
6233 They aren't parameters, right? */
6234 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6235 {
6236 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6237 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6238 block);
6239 }
6240 }
6241 }
6242 \f
6243
6244 /* Symbol Completion */
6245
6246 /* See symtab.h. */
6247
6248 bool
6249 ada_lookup_name_info::matches
6250 (const char *sym_name,
6251 symbol_name_match_type match_type,
6252 completion_match_result *comp_match_res) const
6253 {
6254 bool match = false;
6255 const char *text = m_encoded_name.c_str ();
6256 size_t text_len = m_encoded_name.size ();
6257
6258 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
6259
6260 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6261 match = true;
6262
6263 std::string decoded_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
6264 if (match && !m_encoded_p)
6265 {
6266 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
6267 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
6268 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
6269 is not a suitable completion. */
6270
6271 bool has_angle_bracket = (decoded_name[0] == '<');
6272 match = (has_angle_bracket == m_verbatim_p);
6273 }
6274
6275 if (match && !m_verbatim_p)
6276 {
6277 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
6278 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
6279 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
6280 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
6281 angle bracket notation. */
6282 const char *tmp;
6283
6284 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
6285 if (*tmp != '\0')
6286 match = false;
6287 }
6288
6289 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
6290
6291 if (!match && m_wild_match_p)
6292 {
6293 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
6294 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
6295 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
6296 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (decoded_name.c_str ());
6297
6298 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6299 match = true;
6300 }
6301
6302 /* Finally: If we found a match, prepare the result to return. */
6303
6304 if (!match)
6305 return false;
6306
6307 if (comp_match_res != NULL)
6308 {
6309 std::string &match_str = comp_match_res->match.storage ();
6310
6311 if (!m_encoded_p)
6312 match_str = ada_decode (sym_name);
6313 else
6314 {
6315 if (m_verbatim_p)
6316 match_str = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
6317 else
6318 match_str = sym_name;
6319
6320 }
6321
6322 comp_match_res->set_match (match_str.c_str ());
6323 }
6324
6325 return true;
6326 }
6327
6328 /* Add the list of possible symbol names completing TEXT to TRACKER.
6329 WORD is the entire command on which completion is made. */
6330
6331 static void
6332 ada_collect_symbol_completion_matches (completion_tracker &tracker,
6333 complete_symbol_mode mode,
6334 symbol_name_match_type name_match_type,
6335 const char *text, const char *word,
6336 enum type_code code)
6337 {
6338 struct symbol *sym;
6339 const struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
6340 struct block_iterator iter;
6341
6342 gdb_assert (code == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF);
6343
6344 lookup_name_info lookup_name (text, name_match_type, true);
6345
6346 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
6347 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL,
6348 lookup_name,
6349 NULL,
6350 NULL,
6351 ALL_DOMAIN);
6352
6353 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
6354 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
6355 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
6356 handled by the psymtab code above). */
6357
6358 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6359 {
6360 for (minimal_symbol *msymbol : objfile->msymbols ())
6361 {
6362 QUIT;
6363
6364 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, msymbol))
6365 continue;
6366
6367 language symbol_language = msymbol->language ();
6368
6369 /* Ada minimal symbols won't have their language set to Ada. If
6370 we let completion_list_add_name compare using the
6371 default/C-like matcher, then when completing e.g., symbols in a
6372 package named "pck", we'd match internal Ada symbols like
6373 "pckS", which are invalid in an Ada expression, unless you wrap
6374 them in '<' '>' to request a verbatim match.
6375
6376 Unfortunately, some Ada encoded names successfully demangle as
6377 C++ symbols (using an old mangling scheme), such as "name__2Xn"
6378 -> "Xn::name(void)" and thus some Ada minimal symbols end up
6379 with the wrong language set. Paper over that issue here. */
6380 if (symbol_language == language_auto
6381 || symbol_language == language_cplus)
6382 symbol_language = language_ada;
6383
6384 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6385 symbol_language,
6386 msymbol->linkage_name (),
6387 lookup_name, text, word);
6388 }
6389 }
6390
6391 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
6392 complete on local vars. */
6393
6394 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6395 {
6396 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6397 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
6398
6399 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6400 {
6401 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6402 continue;
6403
6404 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6405 sym->language (),
6406 sym->linkage_name (),
6407 lookup_name, text, word);
6408 }
6409 }
6410
6411 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
6412 symbols which match. */
6413
6414 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6415 {
6416 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
6417 {
6418 QUIT;
6419 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
6420 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6421 {
6422 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6423 continue;
6424
6425 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6426 sym->language (),
6427 sym->linkage_name (),
6428 lookup_name, text, word);
6429 }
6430 }
6431 }
6432
6433 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6434 {
6435 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
6436 {
6437 QUIT;
6438 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
6439 /* Don't do this block twice. */
6440 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
6441 continue;
6442 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6443 {
6444 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6445 continue;
6446
6447 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6448 sym->language (),
6449 sym->linkage_name (),
6450 lookup_name, text, word);
6451 }
6452 }
6453 }
6454 }
6455
6456 /* Field Access */
6457
6458 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
6459 for tagged types. */
6460
6461 static int
6462 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
6463 {
6464 const char *name;
6465
6466 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6467 return 0;
6468
6469 name = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)->name ();
6470 if (name == NULL)
6471 return 0;
6472
6473 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6474 }
6475
6476 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is an interface tag. */
6477
6478 static int
6479 ada_is_interface_tag (struct type *type)
6480 {
6481 const char *name = type->name ();
6482
6483 if (name == NULL)
6484 return 0;
6485
6486 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__interface_tag") == 0);
6487 }
6488
6489 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
6490 to be invisible to users. */
6491
6492 int
6493 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6494 {
6495 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > type->num_fields ())
6496 return 1;
6497
6498 /* Check the name of that field. */
6499 {
6500 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6501
6502 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
6503 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
6504 but we don't want to print the value of anonymous fields anyway. */
6505 if (name == NULL)
6506 return 1;
6507
6508 /* Normally, fields whose name start with an underscore ("_")
6509 are fields that have been internally generated by the compiler,
6510 and thus should not be printed. The "_parent" field is special,
6511 however: This is a field internally generated by the compiler
6512 for tagged types, and it contains the components inherited from
6513 the parent type. This field should not be printed as is, but
6514 should not be ignored either. */
6515 if (name[0] == '_' && !startswith (name, "_parent"))
6516 return 1;
6517 }
6518
6519 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type or an interface tag,
6520 then ignore. */
6521 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
6522 && (ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))
6523 || ada_is_interface_tag (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))))
6524 return 1;
6525
6526 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
6527 return 0;
6528 }
6529
6530 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
6531 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
6532
6533 int
6534 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
6535 {
6536 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1) != NULL);
6537 }
6538
6539 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
6540
6541 int
6542 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
6543 {
6544 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6545
6546 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6547 return 0;
6548 else
6549 {
6550 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6551
6552 return (name != NULL
6553 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6554 }
6555 }
6556
6557 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
6558
6559 static struct type *
6560 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
6561 {
6562 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0);
6563 }
6564
6565 /* Return 1 if TAG follows the old scheme for Ada tags (used for Ada 95,
6566 retired at Ada 05). */
6567
6568 static int
6569 is_ada95_tag (struct value *tag)
6570 {
6571 return ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1) != NULL;
6572 }
6573
6574 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
6575
6576 static struct value *
6577 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
6578 {
6579 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
6580 }
6581
6582 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
6583 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
6584 ADDRESS. */
6585
6586 static struct value *
6587 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
6588 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6589 CORE_ADDR address)
6590 {
6591 int tag_byte_offset;
6592 struct type *tag_type;
6593
6594 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
6595 NULL, NULL, NULL))
6596 {
6597 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
6598 ? NULL
6599 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
6600 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
6601
6602 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
6603 }
6604 return NULL;
6605 }
6606
6607 static struct type *
6608 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6609 {
6610 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
6611
6612 if (type_name != NULL)
6613 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
6614 return NULL;
6615 }
6616
6617 /* Given a value OBJ of a tagged type, return a value of this
6618 type at the base address of the object. The base address, as
6619 defined in Ada.Tags, it is the address of the primary tag of
6620 the object, and therefore where the field values of its full
6621 view can be fetched. */
6622
6623 struct value *
6624 ada_tag_value_at_base_address (struct value *obj)
6625 {
6626 struct value *val;
6627 LONGEST offset_to_top = 0;
6628 struct type *ptr_type, *obj_type;
6629 struct value *tag;
6630 CORE_ADDR base_address;
6631
6632 obj_type = value_type (obj);
6633
6634 /* It is the responsability of the caller to deref pointers. */
6635
6636 if (obj_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR || obj_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6637 return obj;
6638
6639 tag = ada_value_tag (obj);
6640 if (!tag)
6641 return obj;
6642
6643 /* Base addresses only appeared with Ada 05 and multiple inheritance. */
6644
6645 if (is_ada95_tag (tag))
6646 return obj;
6647
6648 ptr_type = language_lookup_primitive_type
6649 (language_def (language_ada), target_gdbarch(), "storage_offset");
6650 ptr_type = lookup_pointer_type (ptr_type);
6651 val = value_cast (ptr_type, tag);
6652 if (!val)
6653 return obj;
6654
6655 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while
6656 trying to determine the base address, just like for the tag;
6657 see ada_tag_name for more details. We do not print the error
6658 message for the same reason. */
6659
6660 try
6661 {
6662 offset_to_top = value_as_long (value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -2)));
6663 }
6664
6665 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
6666 {
6667 return obj;
6668 }
6669
6670 /* If offset is null, nothing to do. */
6671
6672 if (offset_to_top == 0)
6673 return obj;
6674
6675 /* -1 is a special case in Ada.Tags; however, what should be done
6676 is not quite clear from the documentation. So do nothing for
6677 now. */
6678
6679 if (offset_to_top == -1)
6680 return obj;
6681
6682 /* OFFSET_TO_TOP used to be a positive value to be subtracted
6683 from the base address. This was however incompatible with
6684 C++ dispatch table: C++ uses a *negative* value to *add*
6685 to the base address. Ada's convention has therefore been
6686 changed in GNAT 19.0w 20171023: since then, C++ and Ada
6687 use the same convention. Here, we support both cases by
6688 checking the sign of OFFSET_TO_TOP. */
6689
6690 if (offset_to_top > 0)
6691 offset_to_top = -offset_to_top;
6692
6693 base_address = value_address (obj) + offset_to_top;
6694 tag = value_tag_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6695
6696 /* Make sure that we have a proper tag at the new address.
6697 Otherwise, offset_to_top is bogus (which can happen when
6698 the object is not initialized yet). */
6699
6700 if (!tag)
6701 return obj;
6702
6703 obj_type = type_from_tag (tag);
6704
6705 if (!obj_type)
6706 return obj;
6707
6708 return value_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6709 }
6710
6711 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */
6712
6713 static struct type *
6714 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf)
6715 {
6716 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf);
6717
6718 if (data->tsd_type == 0)
6719 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
6720 return data->tsd_type;
6721 }
6722
6723 /* Return the TSD (type-specific data) associated to the given TAG.
6724 TAG is assumed to be the tag of a tagged-type entity.
6725
6726 May return NULL if we are unable to get the TSD. */
6727
6728 static struct value *
6729 ada_get_tsd_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6730 {
6731 struct value *val;
6732 struct type *type;
6733
6734 /* First option: The TSD is simply stored as a field of our TAG.
6735 Only older versions of GNAT would use this format, but we have
6736 to test it first, because there are no visible markers for
6737 the current approach except the absence of that field. */
6738
6739 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1);
6740 if (val)
6741 return val;
6742
6743 /* Try the second representation for the dispatch table (in which
6744 there is no explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer,
6745 and instead the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch
6746 table. */
6747
6748 type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior());
6749 if (type == NULL)
6750 return NULL;
6751 type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (type));
6752 val = value_cast (type, tag);
6753 if (val == NULL)
6754 return NULL;
6755 return value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -1));
6756 }
6757
6758 /* Given the TSD of a tag (type-specific data), return a string
6759 containing the name of the associated type.
6760
6761 The returned value is good until the next call. May return NULL
6762 if we are unable to determine the tag name. */
6763
6764 static char *
6765 ada_tag_name_from_tsd (struct value *tsd)
6766 {
6767 static char name[1024];
6768 char *p;
6769 struct value *val;
6770
6771 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tsd, "expanded_name", 1);
6772 if (val == NULL)
6773 return NULL;
6774 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6775 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6776 if (isalpha (*p))
6777 *p = tolower (*p);
6778 return name;
6779 }
6780
6781 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
6782 a C string.
6783
6784 Return NULL if the TAG is not an Ada tag, or if we were unable to
6785 determine the name of that tag. The result is good until the next
6786 call. */
6787
6788 const char *
6789 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
6790 {
6791 char *name = NULL;
6792
6793 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
6794 return NULL;
6795
6796 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while trying
6797 to determine the TAG's name, even under normal circumstances:
6798 The associated variable may be uninitialized or corrupted, for
6799 instance. We do not let any exception propagate past this point.
6800 instead we return NULL.
6801
6802 We also do not print the error message either (which often is very
6803 low-level (Eg: "Cannot read memory at 0x[...]"), but instead let
6804 the caller print a more meaningful message if necessary. */
6805 try
6806 {
6807 struct value *tsd = ada_get_tsd_from_tag (tag);
6808
6809 if (tsd != NULL)
6810 name = ada_tag_name_from_tsd (tsd);
6811 }
6812 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
6813 {
6814 }
6815
6816 return name;
6817 }
6818
6819 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
6820
6821 struct type *
6822 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
6823 {
6824 int i;
6825
6826 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6827
6828 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6829 return NULL;
6830
6831 for (i = 0; i < type->num_fields (); i += 1)
6832 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
6833 {
6834 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6835
6836 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
6837 if (parent_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6838 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
6839 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
6840 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
6841
6842 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
6843 }
6844
6845 return NULL;
6846 }
6847
6848 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
6849 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
6850 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6851
6852 int
6853 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6854 {
6855 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
6856
6857 return (name != NULL
6858 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6859 || startswith (name, "_parent")));
6860 }
6861
6862 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
6863 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
6864 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
6865 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
6866 structures. */
6867
6868 int
6869 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6870 {
6871 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6872
6873 if (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "RETVAL") == 0)
6874 {
6875 /* This happens in functions with "out" or "in out" parameters
6876 which are passed by copy. For such functions, GNAT describes
6877 the function's return type as being a struct where the return
6878 value is in a field called RETVAL, and where the other "out"
6879 or "in out" parameters are fields of that struct. This is not
6880 a wrapper. */
6881 return 0;
6882 }
6883
6884 return (name != NULL
6885 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6886 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
6887 || startswith (name, "_parent")
6888 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
6889 }
6890
6891 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
6892 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
6893 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6894
6895 int
6896 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
6897 {
6898 /* Only Ada types are eligible. */
6899 if (!ADA_TYPE_P (type))
6900 return 0;
6901
6902 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
6903
6904 return (field_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_UNION
6905 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
6906 && (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type)->code ()
6907 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
6908 }
6909
6910 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
6911 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
6912 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
6913 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
6914
6915 struct type *
6916 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6917 {
6918 const char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6919
6920 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1);
6921 }
6922
6923 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
6924 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
6925 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
6926
6927 static int
6928 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
6929 {
6930 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6931
6932 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
6933 }
6934
6935 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
6936 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
6937 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
6938
6939 const char *
6940 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
6941 {
6942 static char *result = NULL;
6943 static size_t result_len = 0;
6944 struct type *type;
6945 const char *name;
6946 const char *discrim_end;
6947 const char *discrim_start;
6948
6949 if (type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6950 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6951 else
6952 type = type0;
6953
6954 name = ada_type_name (type);
6955
6956 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
6957 return "";
6958
6959 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
6960 discrim_end -= 1)
6961 {
6962 if (startswith (discrim_end, "___XVN"))
6963 break;
6964 }
6965 if (discrim_end == name)
6966 return "";
6967
6968 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
6969 discrim_start -= 1)
6970 {
6971 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
6972 return "";
6973 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
6974 && startswith (discrim_start - 3, "___"))
6975 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
6976 break;
6977 }
6978
6979 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
6980 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
6981 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
6982 return result;
6983 }
6984
6985 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
6986 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
6987 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
6988 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
6989 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
6990 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
6991 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
6992
6993 int
6994 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
6995 {
6996 ULONGEST RU;
6997
6998 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
6999 return 0;
7000
7001 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
7002 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
7003 LONGEST. */
7004 RU = 0;
7005 while (isdigit (str[k]))
7006 {
7007 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
7008 k += 1;
7009 }
7010
7011 if (str[k] == 'm')
7012 {
7013 if (R != NULL)
7014 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
7015 k += 1;
7016 }
7017 else if (R != NULL)
7018 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
7019
7020 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
7021 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
7022 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
7023 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
7024 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
7025
7026 if (new_k != NULL)
7027 *new_k = k;
7028 return 1;
7029 }
7030
7031 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
7032 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
7033 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
7034
7035 static int
7036 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
7037 {
7038 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
7039 int p;
7040
7041 p = 0;
7042 while (1)
7043 {
7044 switch (name[p])
7045 {
7046 case '\0':
7047 return 0;
7048 case 'S':
7049 {
7050 LONGEST W;
7051
7052 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
7053 return 0;
7054 if (val == W)
7055 return 1;
7056 break;
7057 }
7058 case 'R':
7059 {
7060 LONGEST L, U;
7061
7062 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
7063 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
7064 return 0;
7065 if (val >= L && val <= U)
7066 return 1;
7067 break;
7068 }
7069 case 'O':
7070 return 1;
7071 default:
7072 return 0;
7073 }
7074 }
7075 }
7076
7077 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
7078
7079 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
7080 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
7081 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
7082 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
7083
7084 struct value *
7085 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
7086 struct type *arg_type)
7087 {
7088 struct type *type;
7089
7090 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
7091 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
7092
7093 /* Handle packed fields. It might be that the field is not packed
7094 relative to its containing structure, but the structure itself is
7095 packed; in this case we must take the bit-field path. */
7096 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0 || value_bitpos (arg1) != 0)
7097 {
7098 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
7099 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
7100
7101 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
7102 offset + bit_pos / 8,
7103 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
7104 }
7105 else
7106 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
7107 }
7108
7109 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
7110 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
7111 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
7112 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
7113 an object of that type;
7114 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
7115 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
7116 0 otherwise;
7117 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
7118 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
7119 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
7120 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
7121
7122 Notice that we need to handle when a tagged record hierarchy
7123 has some components with the same name, like in this scenario:
7124
7125 type Top_T is tagged record
7126 N : Integer := 1;
7127 U : Integer := 974;
7128 A : Integer := 48;
7129 end record;
7130
7131 type Middle_T is new Top.Top_T with record
7132 N : Character := 'a';
7133 C : Integer := 3;
7134 end record;
7135
7136 type Bottom_T is new Middle.Middle_T with record
7137 N : Float := 4.0;
7138 C : Character := '5';
7139 X : Integer := 6;
7140 A : Character := 'J';
7141 end record;
7142
7143 Let's say we now have a variable declared and initialized as follow:
7144
7145 TC : Top_A := new Bottom_T;
7146
7147 And then we use this variable to call this function
7148
7149 procedure Assign (Obj: in out Top_T; TV : Integer);
7150
7151 as follow:
7152
7153 Assign (Top_T (B), 12);
7154
7155 Now, we're in the debugger, and we're inside that procedure
7156 then and we want to print the value of obj.c:
7157
7158 Usually, the tagged record or one of the parent type owns the
7159 component to print and there's no issue but in this particular
7160 case, what does it mean to ask for Obj.C? Since the actual
7161 type for object is type Bottom_T, it could mean two things: type
7162 component C from the Middle_T view, but also component C from
7163 Bottom_T. So in that "undefined" case, when the component is
7164 not found in the non-resolved type (which includes all the
7165 components of the parent type), then resolve it and see if we
7166 get better luck once expanded.
7167
7168 In the case of homonyms in the derived tagged type, we don't
7169 guaranty anything, and pick the one that's easiest for us
7170 to program.
7171
7172 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
7173
7174 static int
7175 find_struct_field (const char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
7176 struct type **field_type_p,
7177 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
7178 int *index_p)
7179 {
7180 int i;
7181 int parent_offset = -1;
7182
7183 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7184
7185 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7186 *field_type_p = NULL;
7187 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7188 *byte_offset_p = 0;
7189 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7190 *bit_offset_p = 0;
7191 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7192 *bit_size_p = 0;
7193
7194 for (i = 0; i < type->num_fields (); i += 1)
7195 {
7196 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
7197 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
7198 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7199
7200 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7201 continue;
7202
7203 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7204 {
7205 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7206 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7207 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7208 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7209 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7210 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7211 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7212
7213 parent_offset = i;
7214 continue;
7215 }
7216
7217 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7218 {
7219 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
7220
7221 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7222 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7223 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7224 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
7225 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7226 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
7227 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7228 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
7229 return 1;
7230 }
7231 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7232 {
7233 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
7234 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
7235 bit_size_p, index_p))
7236 return 1;
7237 }
7238 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7239 {
7240 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
7241 fixed type?? */
7242 int j;
7243 struct type *field_type
7244 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7245
7246 for (j = 0; j < field_type->num_fields (); j += 1)
7247 {
7248 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
7249 fld_offset
7250 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7251 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
7252 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
7253 return 1;
7254 }
7255 }
7256 else if (index_p != NULL)
7257 *index_p += 1;
7258 }
7259
7260 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7261 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7262
7263 if (parent_offset != -1)
7264 {
7265 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, parent_offset);
7266 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
7267
7268 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset),
7269 fld_offset, field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
7270 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
7271 return 1;
7272 }
7273
7274 return 0;
7275 }
7276
7277 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
7278
7279 static int
7280 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
7281 {
7282 int n;
7283
7284 n = 0;
7285 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
7286 return n;
7287 }
7288
7289 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
7290 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7291 If found, return value, else return NULL.
7292
7293 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent').
7294
7295 In the case of homonyms in the tagged types, please refer to the
7296 long explanation in find_struct_field's function documentation. */
7297
7298 static struct value *
7299 ada_search_struct_field (const char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
7300 struct type *type)
7301 {
7302 int i;
7303 int parent_offset = -1;
7304
7305 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7306 for (i = 0; i < type->num_fields (); i += 1)
7307 {
7308 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7309
7310 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7311 continue;
7312
7313 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7314 {
7315 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7316 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7317 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7318 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7319 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7320 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7321 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7322
7323 parent_offset = i;
7324 continue;
7325 }
7326
7327 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7328 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7329
7330 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7331 {
7332 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7333 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
7334 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7335 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7336
7337 if (v != NULL)
7338 return v;
7339 }
7340
7341 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7342 {
7343 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
7344 int j;
7345 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7346 i));
7347 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7348
7349 for (j = 0; j < field_type->num_fields (); j += 1)
7350 {
7351 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line
7352 break. */
7353 (name, arg,
7354 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7355 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
7356
7357 if (v != NULL)
7358 return v;
7359 }
7360 }
7361 }
7362
7363 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7364 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7365
7366 if (parent_offset != -1)
7367 {
7368 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field (
7369 name, arg, offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, parent_offset) / 8,
7370 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset));
7371
7372 if (v != NULL)
7373 return v;
7374 }
7375
7376 return NULL;
7377 }
7378
7379 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
7380 int, struct type *);
7381
7382
7383 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
7384 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
7385 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7386 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
7387
7388 static struct value *
7389 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
7390 struct type *type)
7391 {
7392 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
7393 }
7394
7395
7396 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
7397 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
7398 * *INDEX_P. */
7399
7400 static struct value *
7401 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
7402 struct type *type)
7403 {
7404 int i;
7405 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7406
7407 for (i = 0; i < type->num_fields (); i += 1)
7408 {
7409 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
7410 continue;
7411 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7412 {
7413 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7414 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
7415 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7416 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7417
7418 if (v != NULL)
7419 return v;
7420 }
7421
7422 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7423 {
7424 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
7425 find_struct_field. */
7426 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
7427 }
7428 else if (*index_p == 0)
7429 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7430 else
7431 *index_p -= 1;
7432 }
7433 return NULL;
7434 }
7435
7436 /* Return a string representation of type TYPE. */
7437
7438 static std::string
7439 type_as_string (struct type *type)
7440 {
7441 string_file tmp_stream;
7442
7443 type_print (type, "", &tmp_stream, -1);
7444
7445 return std::move (tmp_stream.string ());
7446 }
7447
7448 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
7449 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
7450 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
7451 work for packed fields).
7452
7453 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
7454 followed by "___".
7455
7456 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
7457 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
7458 ultimate target type will be searched.
7459
7460 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
7461
7462 In the case of homonyms in the tagged types, please refer to the
7463 long explanation in find_struct_field's function documentation.
7464
7465 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
7466 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
7467
7468 static struct type *
7469 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, const char *name, int refok,
7470 int noerr)
7471 {
7472 int i;
7473 int parent_offset = -1;
7474
7475 if (name == NULL)
7476 goto BadName;
7477
7478 if (refok && type != NULL)
7479 while (1)
7480 {
7481 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7482 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_REF)
7483 break;
7484 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
7485 }
7486
7487 if (type == NULL
7488 || (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7489 && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
7490 {
7491 if (noerr)
7492 return NULL;
7493
7494 error (_("Type %s is not a structure or union type"),
7495 type != NULL ? type_as_string (type).c_str () : _("(null)"));
7496 }
7497
7498 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7499
7500 for (i = 0; i < type->num_fields (); i += 1)
7501 {
7502 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7503 struct type *t;
7504
7505 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7506 continue;
7507
7508 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7509 {
7510 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7511 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7512 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7513 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7514 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7515 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7516 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7517
7518 parent_offset = i;
7519 continue;
7520 }
7521
7522 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7523 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7524
7525 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7526 {
7527 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
7528 0, 1);
7529 if (t != NULL)
7530 return t;
7531 }
7532
7533 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7534 {
7535 int j;
7536 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7537 i));
7538
7539 for (j = field_type->num_fields () - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
7540 {
7541 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
7542 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
7543 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
7544 if the compiler changes this practice. */
7545 const char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
7546
7547 if (v_field_name != NULL
7548 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
7549 t = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j);
7550 else
7551 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type,
7552 j),
7553 name, 0, 1);
7554
7555 if (t != NULL)
7556 return t;
7557 }
7558 }
7559
7560 }
7561
7562 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7563 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7564
7565 if (parent_offset != -1)
7566 {
7567 struct type *t;
7568
7569 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset),
7570 name, 0, 1);
7571 if (t != NULL)
7572 return t;
7573 }
7574
7575 BadName:
7576 if (!noerr)
7577 {
7578 const char *name_str = name != NULL ? name : _("<null>");
7579
7580 error (_("Type %s has no component named %s"),
7581 type_as_string (type).c_str (), name_str);
7582 }
7583
7584 return NULL;
7585 }
7586
7587 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7588 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
7589 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
7590 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
7591
7592 static int
7593 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
7594 {
7595 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7596
7597 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1) == NULL);
7598 }
7599
7600
7601 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7602 within OUTER, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
7603 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
7604
7605 int
7606 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct value *outer)
7607 {
7608 int others_clause;
7609 int i;
7610 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7611 struct value *discrim;
7612 LONGEST discrim_val;
7613
7614 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes problems
7615 because we will end up trying to resolve a type that is currently
7616 being constructed. */
7617 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
7618 if (discrim == NULL)
7619 return -1;
7620 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
7621
7622 others_clause = -1;
7623 for (i = 0; i < var_type->num_fields (); i += 1)
7624 {
7625 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
7626 others_clause = i;
7627 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
7628 return i;
7629 }
7630
7631 return others_clause;
7632 }
7633 \f
7634
7635
7636 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
7637
7638 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
7639 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
7640 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
7641 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
7642 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
7643
7644 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
7645 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
7646 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
7647 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
7648 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
7649 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
7650 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
7651 rather than struct value*s.
7652
7653 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
7654 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
7655 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
7656 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
7657 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
7658 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
7659 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
7660 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
7661 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
7662 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
7663 element selected. */
7664
7665 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
7666 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
7667 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
7668 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
7669 target at the target address. */
7670
7671 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
7672 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
7673 dynamic-sized types. */
7674
7675 struct value *
7676 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
7677 {
7678 struct value *val = value_ind (val0);
7679
7680 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7681 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7682
7683 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7684 }
7685
7686 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
7687 qualifiers on VAL0. */
7688
7689 static struct value *
7690 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
7691 {
7692 if (value_type (val0)->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
7693 {
7694 struct value *val = val0;
7695
7696 val = coerce_ref (val);
7697
7698 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7699 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7700
7701 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7702 }
7703 else
7704 return val0;
7705 }
7706
7707 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
7708
7709 static unsigned int
7710 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
7711 {
7712 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7713 int len;
7714 int align_offset;
7715
7716 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
7717 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
7718 require any alignment. */
7719 if (name == NULL)
7720 return 1;
7721
7722 len = strlen (name);
7723
7724 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
7725 return 1;
7726
7727 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
7728 align_offset = len - 2;
7729 else
7730 align_offset = len - 1;
7731
7732 if (align_offset < 7 || !startswith (name + align_offset - 6, "___XV"))
7733 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7734
7735 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7736 }
7737
7738 /* Find a typedef or tag symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
7739
7740 static struct symbol *
7741 ada_find_any_type_symbol (const char *name)
7742 {
7743 struct symbol *sym;
7744
7745 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
7746 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
7747 return sym;
7748
7749 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
7750 return sym;
7751 }
7752
7753 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
7754 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
7755 primitive types. */
7756
7757 static struct type *
7758 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
7759 {
7760 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7761
7762 if (sym != NULL)
7763 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
7764
7765 return NULL;
7766 }
7767
7768 /* Given NAME_SYM and an associated BLOCK, find a "renaming" symbol
7769 associated with NAME_SYM's name. NAME_SYM may itself be a renaming
7770 symbol, in which case it is returned. Otherwise, this looks for
7771 symbols whose name is that of NAME_SYM suffixed with "___XR".
7772 Return symbol if found, and NULL otherwise. */
7773
7774 static bool
7775 ada_is_renaming_symbol (struct symbol *name_sym)
7776 {
7777 const char *name = name_sym->linkage_name ();
7778 return strstr (name, "___XR") != NULL;
7779 }
7780
7781 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
7782 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
7783 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
7784 otherwise return 0. */
7785
7786 int
7787 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
7788 {
7789 if (type1 == NULL)
7790 return 1;
7791 else if (type0 == NULL)
7792 return 0;
7793 else if (type1->code () == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7794 return 1;
7795 else if (type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7796 return 0;
7797 else if (type1->name () == NULL && type0->name () != NULL)
7798 return 1;
7799 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
7800 return 1;
7801 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
7802 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
7803 return 1;
7804 else
7805 {
7806 const char *type0_name = type0->name ();
7807 const char *type1_name = type1->name ();
7808
7809 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
7810 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
7811 return 1;
7812 }
7813 return 0;
7814 }
7815
7816 /* The name of TYPE, which is its TYPE_NAME. Null if TYPE is
7817 null. */
7818
7819 const char *
7820 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
7821 {
7822 if (type == NULL)
7823 return NULL;
7824 return type->name ();
7825 }
7826
7827 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type
7828 whose name is NAME. */
7829
7830 static struct type *
7831 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name)
7832 {
7833 struct type *result, *tmp;
7834
7835 if (ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p)
7836 return NULL;
7837
7838 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type
7839 to be found. */
7840 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7841 return NULL;
7842
7843 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type);
7844 while (result != NULL)
7845 {
7846 const char *result_name = ada_type_name (result);
7847
7848 if (result_name == NULL)
7849 {
7850 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type"));
7851 return NULL;
7852 }
7853
7854 /* If the names match, stop. */
7855 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0)
7856 break;
7857
7858 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */
7859 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7860 tmp = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7861 else
7862 tmp = NULL;
7863
7864 /* If not found either, try after having resolved the typedef. */
7865 if (tmp != NULL)
7866 result = tmp;
7867 else
7868 {
7869 result = check_typedef (result);
7870 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7871 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7872 else
7873 result = NULL;
7874 }
7875 }
7876
7877 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With
7878 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or
7879 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails.
7880 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */
7881 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
7882 return ada_find_any_type (name);
7883
7884 return result;
7885 }
7886
7887 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the
7888 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available,
7889 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */
7890
7891 static struct type *
7892 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name)
7893 {
7894 struct type *result = NULL;
7895
7896 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7897 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name);
7898 else
7899 result = ada_find_any_type (name);
7900
7901 return result;
7902 }
7903
7904 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending
7905 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
7906
7907 struct type *
7908 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
7909 {
7910 char *name;
7911 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type);
7912 int len;
7913
7914 if (type_name == NULL)
7915 return NULL;
7916
7917 len = strlen (type_name);
7918
7919 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
7920
7921 strcpy (name, type_name);
7922 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
7923
7924 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
7925 }
7926
7927 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
7928 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
7929
7930 static struct type *
7931 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
7932 {
7933 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7934
7935 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7936 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
7937 return NULL;
7938 else
7939 {
7940 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
7941
7942 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
7943 return type;
7944 else
7945 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
7946 }
7947 }
7948
7949 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
7950 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
7951
7952 static int
7953 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
7954 {
7955 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
7956
7957 return name != NULL
7958 && TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7959 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
7960 }
7961
7962 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
7963 represent a variant record type. */
7964
7965 static int
7966 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
7967 {
7968 int f;
7969
7970 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7971 return -1;
7972
7973 for (f = 0; f < type->num_fields (); f += 1)
7974 {
7975 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7976 return f;
7977 }
7978 return -1;
7979 }
7980
7981 /* A record type with no fields. */
7982
7983 static struct type *
7984 empty_record (struct type *templ)
7985 {
7986 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (templ);
7987
7988 type->set_code (TYPE_CODE_STRUCT);
7989 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (type);
7990 type->set_name ("<empty>");
7991 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7992 return type;
7993 }
7994
7995 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7996 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
7997 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
7998 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
7999 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
8000 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
8001 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
8002 of the variant.
8003
8004 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
8005 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
8006 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
8007
8008 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
8009 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
8010 byte-aligned. */
8011
8012 struct type *
8013 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
8014 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8015 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
8016 int keep_dynamic_fields)
8017 {
8018 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8019 struct value *dval;
8020 struct type *rtype;
8021 int nfields, bit_len;
8022 int variant_field;
8023 long off;
8024 int fld_bit_len;
8025 int f;
8026
8027 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
8028 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
8029 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
8030 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
8031 nfields = type->num_fields ();
8032 else
8033 {
8034 nfields = 0;
8035 while (nfields < type->num_fields ()
8036 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
8037 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
8038 nfields++;
8039 }
8040
8041 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8042 rtype->set_code (TYPE_CODE_STRUCT);
8043 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8044 rtype->set_num_fields (nfields);
8045 rtype->set_fields
8046 ((struct field *) TYPE_ZALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field)));
8047 rtype->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
8048 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8049
8050 off = 0;
8051 bit_len = 0;
8052 variant_field = -1;
8053
8054 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8055 {
8056 off = align_up (off, field_alignment (type, f))
8057 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
8058 SET_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype->field (f), off);
8059 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
8060
8061 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
8062 {
8063 variant_field = f;
8064 fld_bit_len = 0;
8065 }
8066 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
8067 {
8068 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
8069 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
8070 struct type *field_type =
8071 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
8072
8073 if (dval0 == NULL)
8074 {
8075 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
8076 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
8077 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
8078 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
8079 size first before creating the value. */
8080 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (rtype);
8081 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here
8082 causes problems because we will end up trying to
8083 resolve a type that is currently being
8084 constructed. */
8085 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype,
8086 valaddr,
8087 address);
8088 rtype = value_type (dval);
8089 }
8090 else
8091 dval = dval0;
8092
8093 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
8094 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
8095 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
8096 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
8097 that follow this one. */
8098 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
8099 {
8100 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
8101
8102 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
8103 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
8104 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
8105 }
8106
8107 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
8108 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8109 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
8110 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8111
8112 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
8113 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
8114 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
8115 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
8116 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
8117 would end up in an infinite loop. */
8118 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
8119 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
8120 field_address, dval, 0);
8121 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum
8122 object size, then the record itself will necessarily
8123 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make
8124 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously
8125 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior)
8126 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the
8127 record size. */
8128 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (field_type);
8129
8130 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
8131 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8132 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because
8133 the field length has been size-checked just above, and
8134 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value,
8135 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than
8136 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code,
8137 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */
8138 fld_bit_len =
8139 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8140 }
8141 else
8142 {
8143 /* Note: If this field's type is a typedef, it is important
8144 to preserve the typedef layer.
8145
8146 Otherwise, we might be transforming a typedef to a fat
8147 pointer (encoding a pointer to an unconstrained array),
8148 into a basic fat pointer (encoding an unconstrained
8149 array). As both types are implemented using the same
8150 structure, the typedef is the only clue which allows us
8151 to distinguish between the two options. Stripping it
8152 would prevent us from printing this field appropriately. */
8153 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8154 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8155 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
8156 fld_bit_len =
8157 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
8158 else
8159 {
8160 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8161
8162 /* We need to be careful of typedefs when computing
8163 the length of our field. If this is a typedef,
8164 get the length of the target type, not the length
8165 of the typedef. */
8166 if (field_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8167 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type);
8168
8169 fld_bit_len =
8170 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8171 }
8172 }
8173 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8174 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8175 off += fld_bit_len;
8176 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8177 align_up (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8178 }
8179
8180 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
8181 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
8182 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
8183 clauses. */
8184 if (variant_field >= 0)
8185 {
8186 struct type *branch_type;
8187
8188 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
8189
8190 if (dval0 == NULL)
8191 {
8192 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes
8193 problems because we will end up trying to resolve a type
8194 that is currently being constructed. */
8195 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype, valaddr,
8196 address);
8197 rtype = value_type (dval);
8198 }
8199 else
8200 dval = dval0;
8201
8202 branch_type =
8203 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8204 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8205 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8206 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8207 if (branch_type == NULL)
8208 {
8209 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < rtype->num_fields (); f += 1)
8210 rtype->field (f - 1) = rtype->field (f);
8211 rtype->set_num_fields (rtype->num_fields () - 1);
8212 }
8213 else
8214 {
8215 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8216 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8217 fld_bit_len =
8218 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
8219 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8220 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8221 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8222 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8223 align_up (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8224 }
8225 }
8226
8227 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
8228 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
8229 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
8230 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
8231 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
8232 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
8233 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
8234 {
8235 if (rtype->name ())
8236 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %s."),
8237 rtype->name (), pulongest (TYPE_LENGTH (type)));
8238 else
8239 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %s."),
8240 pulongest (TYPE_LENGTH (type)));
8241 }
8242 else
8243 {
8244 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_up (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
8245 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
8246 }
8247
8248 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8249 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
8250 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8251 return rtype;
8252 }
8253
8254 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
8255 of 1. */
8256
8257 static struct type *
8258 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8259 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8260 {
8261 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
8262 address, dval0, 1);
8263 }
8264
8265 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
8266 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
8267 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
8268 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
8269 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
8270 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
8271 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
8272 template type. */
8273
8274 static struct type *
8275 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8276 {
8277 struct type *type;
8278 int nfields;
8279 int f;
8280
8281 /* No need no do anything if the input type is already fixed. */
8282 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8283 return type0;
8284
8285 /* Likewise if we already have computed the static approximation. */
8286 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
8287 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
8288
8289 /* Don't clone TYPE0 until we are sure we are going to need a copy. */
8290 type = type0;
8291 nfields = type0->num_fields ();
8292
8293 /* Whether or not we cloned TYPE0, cache the result so that we don't do
8294 recompute all over next time. */
8295 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type;
8296
8297 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8298 {
8299 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f);
8300 struct type *new_type;
8301
8302 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
8303 {
8304 field_type = ada_check_typedef (field_type);
8305 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
8306 }
8307 else
8308 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
8309
8310 if (new_type != field_type)
8311 {
8312 /* Clone TYPE0 only the first time we get a new field type. */
8313 if (type == type0)
8314 {
8315 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
8316 type->set_code (type0->code ());
8317 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (type);
8318 type->set_num_fields (nfields);
8319
8320 field *fields =
8321 ((struct field *)
8322 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field)));
8323 memcpy (fields, type0->fields (),
8324 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8325 type->set_fields (fields);
8326
8327 type->set_name (ada_type_name (type0));
8328 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
8329 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
8330 }
8331 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
8332 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
8333 }
8334 }
8335
8336 return type;
8337 }
8338
8339 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
8340 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
8341 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
8342 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
8343 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
8344 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
8345
8346 static struct type *
8347 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8348 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8349 {
8350 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8351 struct value *dval;
8352 struct type *rtype;
8353 struct type *branch_type;
8354 int nfields = type->num_fields ();
8355 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
8356
8357 if (variant_field == -1)
8358 return type;
8359
8360 if (dval0 == NULL)
8361 {
8362 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
8363 type = value_type (dval);
8364 }
8365 else
8366 dval = dval0;
8367
8368 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8369 rtype->set_code (TYPE_CODE_STRUCT);
8370 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8371 rtype->set_num_fields (nfields);
8372
8373 field *fields =
8374 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8375 memcpy (fields, type->fields (), sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8376 rtype->set_fields (fields);
8377
8378 rtype->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
8379 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8380 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
8381
8382 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8383 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8384 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
8385 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8386 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8387 cond_offset_target (address,
8388 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8389 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8390 if (branch_type == NULL)
8391 {
8392 int f;
8393
8394 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
8395 rtype->field (f - 1) = rtype->field (f);
8396 rtype->set_num_fields (rtype->num_fields () - 1);
8397 }
8398 else
8399 {
8400 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8401 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8402 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
8403 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
8404 }
8405 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
8406
8407 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8408 return rtype;
8409 }
8410
8411 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8412 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
8413 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
8414 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
8415 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
8416 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
8417 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
8418 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
8419 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
8420
8421 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
8422 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
8423 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
8424 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
8425 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
8426 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
8427 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
8428
8429 static struct type *
8430 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8431 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8432 {
8433 struct type *templ_type;
8434
8435 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8436 return type0;
8437
8438 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8439
8440 if (templ_type != NULL)
8441 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
8442 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
8443 {
8444 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
8445 return type0;
8446 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
8447 dval);
8448 }
8449 else
8450 {
8451 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
8452 return type0;
8453 }
8454
8455 }
8456
8457 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8458 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
8459 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
8460 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
8461 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
8462 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
8463 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
8464
8465 static struct type *
8466 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8467 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8468 {
8469 int which;
8470 struct type *templ_type;
8471 struct type *var_type;
8472
8473 if (var_type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8474 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
8475 else
8476 var_type = var_type0;
8477
8478 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
8479
8480 if (templ_type != NULL)
8481 var_type = templ_type;
8482
8483 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
8484 return var_type0;
8485 which = ada_which_variant_applies (var_type, dval);
8486
8487 if (which < 0)
8488 return empty_record (var_type);
8489 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
8490 return to_fixed_record_type
8491 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
8492 valaddr, address, dval);
8493 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
8494 return
8495 to_fixed_record_type
8496 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
8497 else
8498 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
8499 }
8500
8501 /* Assuming RANGE_TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_RANGE, return nonzero if
8502 ENCODING_TYPE, a type following the GNAT conventions for discrete
8503 type encodings, only carries redundant information. */
8504
8505 static int
8506 ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (struct type *range_type,
8507 struct type *encoding_type)
8508 {
8509 const char *bounds_str;
8510 int n;
8511 LONGEST lo, hi;
8512
8513 gdb_assert (range_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE);
8514
8515 if (get_base_type (range_type)->code ()
8516 != get_base_type (encoding_type)->code ())
8517 {
8518 /* The compiler probably used a simple base type to describe
8519 the range type instead of the range's actual base type,
8520 expecting us to get the real base type from the encoding
8521 anyway. In this situation, the encoding cannot be ignored
8522 as redundant. */
8523 return 0;
8524 }
8525
8526 if (is_dynamic_type (range_type))
8527 return 0;
8528
8529 if (encoding_type->name () == NULL)
8530 return 0;
8531
8532 bounds_str = strstr (encoding_type->name (), "___XDLU_");
8533 if (bounds_str == NULL)
8534 return 0;
8535
8536 n = 8; /* Skip "___XDLU_". */
8537 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &lo, &n))
8538 return 0;
8539 if (TYPE_LOW_BOUND (range_type) != lo)
8540 return 0;
8541
8542 n += 2; /* Skip the "__" separator between the two bounds. */
8543 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &hi, &n))
8544 return 0;
8545 if (TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (range_type) != hi)
8546 return 0;
8547
8548 return 1;
8549 }
8550
8551 /* Given the array type ARRAY_TYPE, return nonzero if DESC_TYPE,
8552 a type following the GNAT encoding for describing array type
8553 indices, only carries redundant information. */
8554
8555 static int
8556 ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (struct type *array_type,
8557 struct type *desc_type)
8558 {
8559 struct type *this_layer = check_typedef (array_type);
8560 int i;
8561
8562 for (i = 0; i < desc_type->num_fields (); i++)
8563 {
8564 if (!ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (this_layer),
8565 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, i)))
8566 return 0;
8567 this_layer = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (this_layer));
8568 }
8569
8570 return 1;
8571 }
8572
8573 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
8574 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
8575 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
8576 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
8577 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
8578 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
8579 varsize_limit. */
8580
8581 static struct type *
8582 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
8583 int ignore_too_big)
8584 {
8585 struct type *index_type_desc;
8586 struct type *result;
8587 int constrained_packed_array_p;
8588 static const char *xa_suffix = "___XA";
8589
8590 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8591 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8592 return type0;
8593
8594 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8595 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8596 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8597
8598 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, xa_suffix);
8599
8600 /* As mentioned in exp_dbug.ads, for non bit-packed arrays an
8601 encoding suffixed with 'P' may still be generated. If so,
8602 it should be used to find the XA type. */
8603
8604 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8605 {
8606 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type0);
8607
8608 if (type_name != NULL)
8609 {
8610 const int len = strlen (type_name);
8611 char *name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (xa_suffix));
8612
8613 if (type_name[len - 1] == 'P')
8614 {
8615 strcpy (name, type_name);
8616 strcpy (name + len - 1, xa_suffix);
8617 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type0, name);
8618 }
8619 }
8620 }
8621
8622 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
8623 if (index_type_desc != NULL
8624 && ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (type0, index_type_desc))
8625 {
8626 /* Ignore this ___XA parallel type, as it does not bring any
8627 useful information. This allows us to avoid creating fixed
8628 versions of the array's index types, which would be identical
8629 to the original ones. This, in turn, can also help avoid
8630 the creation of fixed versions of the array itself. */
8631 index_type_desc = NULL;
8632 }
8633
8634 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8635 {
8636 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
8637
8638 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8639 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8640 debugging data. */
8641 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8642 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8643 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8644 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8645 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8646 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8647 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8648 consult the object tag. */
8649 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
8650
8651 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
8652 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
8653 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
8654 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
8655 result = type0;
8656 else
8657 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
8658 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
8659 }
8660 else
8661 {
8662 int i;
8663 struct type *elt_type0;
8664
8665 elt_type0 = type0;
8666 for (i = index_type_desc->num_fields (); i > 0; i -= 1)
8667 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8668
8669 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8670 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8671 debugging data. */
8672 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8673 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8674 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8675 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8676 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8677 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8678 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8679 consult the object tag. */
8680 result =
8681 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
8682
8683 elt_type0 = type0;
8684 for (i = index_type_desc->num_fields () - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
8685 {
8686 struct type *range_type =
8687 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval);
8688
8689 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
8690 result, range_type);
8691 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8692 }
8693 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
8694 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8695 }
8696
8697 /* We want to preserve the type name. This can be useful when
8698 trying to get the type name of a value that has already been
8699 printed (for instance, if the user did "print VAR; whatis $". */
8700 result->set_name (type0->name ());
8701
8702 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8703 {
8704 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
8705 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
8706 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
8707 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
8708 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
8709 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8710
8711 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8712 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
8713 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
8714 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
8715 }
8716
8717 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
8718 return result;
8719 }
8720
8721
8722 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
8723 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
8724 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
8725 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
8726 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
8727
8728 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
8729 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
8730 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
8731 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
8732 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
8733
8734 static struct type *
8735 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8736 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8737 {
8738 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8739
8740 /* Only un-fixed types need to be handled here. */
8741 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
8742 return type;
8743
8744 switch (type->code ())
8745 {
8746 default:
8747 return type;
8748 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8749 {
8750 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
8751 struct type *fixed_record_type =
8752 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
8753
8754 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
8755 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
8756 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
8757 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
8758 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
8759 them). */
8760
8761 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
8762 {
8763 struct value *tag =
8764 value_tag_from_contents_and_address
8765 (fixed_record_type,
8766 valaddr,
8767 address);
8768 struct type *real_type = type_from_tag (tag);
8769 struct value *obj =
8770 value_from_contents_and_address (fixed_record_type,
8771 valaddr,
8772 address);
8773 fixed_record_type = value_type (obj);
8774 if (real_type != NULL)
8775 return to_fixed_record_type
8776 (real_type, NULL,
8777 value_address (ada_tag_value_at_base_address (obj)), NULL);
8778 }
8779
8780 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
8781 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
8782 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
8783 {
8784 const char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
8785 char *xvz_name
8786 = (char *) alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
8787 bool xvz_found = false;
8788 LONGEST size;
8789
8790 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
8791 try
8792 {
8793 xvz_found = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, size);
8794 }
8795 catch (const gdb_exception_error &except)
8796 {
8797 /* We found the variable, but somehow failed to read
8798 its value. Rethrow the same error, but with a little
8799 bit more information, to help the user understand
8800 what went wrong (Eg: the variable might have been
8801 optimized out). */
8802 throw_error (except.error,
8803 _("unable to read value of %s (%s)"),
8804 xvz_name, except.what ());
8805 }
8806
8807 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
8808 {
8809 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
8810 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
8811
8812 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
8813 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
8814 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
8815
8816 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
8817 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
8818 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
8819 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
8820 definition.
8821
8822 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
8823 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
8824 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
8825 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
8826 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
8827 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
8828 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
8829 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
8830 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
8831 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
8832 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
8833 }
8834 }
8835 return fixed_record_type;
8836 }
8837 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8838 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
8839 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8840 if (dval == NULL)
8841 return type;
8842 else
8843 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
8844 }
8845 }
8846
8847 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
8848 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
8849
8850 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between
8851 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same
8852 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as
8853 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering:
8854
8855 type String_Access is access String;
8856 S1 : String_Access := null;
8857
8858 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But
8859 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1,
8860 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address
8861 instead.
8862
8863 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that
8864 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before
8865 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */
8866
8867 struct type *
8868 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8869 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8870
8871 {
8872 struct type *fixed_type =
8873 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
8874
8875 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE,
8876 then preserve the typedef layer.
8877
8878 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of
8879 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer
8880 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags
8881 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its
8882 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return
8883 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more
8884 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done.
8885
8886 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is
8887 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers.
8888 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer
8889 only in that situation. But this seems unnecessary so far, probably
8890 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere.
8891 */
8892 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8893 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type))
8894 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type)))
8895 return type;
8896
8897 return fixed_type;
8898 }
8899
8900 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
8901 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
8902
8903 static struct type *
8904 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8905 {
8906 struct type *type;
8907
8908 if (type0 == NULL)
8909 return NULL;
8910
8911 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8912 return type0;
8913
8914 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8915
8916 switch (type0->code ())
8917 {
8918 default:
8919 return type0;
8920 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8921 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8922 if (type != NULL)
8923 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8924 else
8925 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8926 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8927 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
8928 if (type != NULL)
8929 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8930 else
8931 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8932 }
8933 }
8934
8935 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
8936
8937 static struct type *
8938 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
8939 {
8940 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8941 {
8942 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
8943 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
8944 type1->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
8945
8946 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
8947 }
8948 else
8949 {
8950 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
8951
8952 if (raw_real_type == type)
8953 return type;
8954 else
8955 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
8956 }
8957 }
8958
8959 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
8960 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
8961 type Foo;
8962 type FooP is access Foo;
8963 V: FooP;
8964 type Foo is array ...;
8965 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
8966 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
8967 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
8968 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
8969
8970 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
8971 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
8972
8973 struct type *
8974 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
8975 {
8976 if (type == NULL)
8977 return NULL;
8978
8979 /* If our type is an access to an unconstrained array, which is encoded
8980 as a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a fat pointer, then we're done.
8981 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is
8982 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent
8983 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types
8984 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */
8985 if (ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (type))
8986 return type;
8987
8988 type = check_typedef (type);
8989 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
8990 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
8991 || type->name () == NULL)
8992 return type;
8993 else
8994 {
8995 const char *name = type->name ();
8996 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
8997
8998 if (type1 == NULL)
8999 return type;
9000
9001 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with
9002 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array
9003 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case,
9004 strip the typedef layer. */
9005 if (type1->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
9006 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1);
9007
9008 return type1;
9009 }
9010 }
9011
9012 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
9013 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
9014 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
9015 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
9016 creation of struct values]. */
9017
9018 static struct value *
9019 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
9020 struct value *val0)
9021 {
9022 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
9023
9024 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
9025 return val0;
9026
9027 if (VALUE_LVAL (val0) != lval_memory)
9028 {
9029 /* Our value does not live in memory; it could be a convenience
9030 variable, for instance. Create a not_lval value using val0's
9031 contents. */
9032 return value_from_contents (type, value_contents (val0));
9033 }
9034
9035 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
9036 }
9037
9038 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
9039 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
9040 value. */
9041
9042 struct value *
9043 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
9044 {
9045 val = unwrap_value (val);
9046 val = ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val), value_address (val), val);
9047 return val;
9048 }
9049 \f
9050
9051 /* Attributes */
9052
9053 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
9054 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
9055
9056 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
9057 "<?>",
9058
9059 "first",
9060 "last",
9061 "length",
9062 "image",
9063 "max",
9064 "min",
9065 "modulus",
9066 "pos",
9067 "size",
9068 "tag",
9069 "val",
9070 0
9071 };
9072
9073 static const char *
9074 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
9075 {
9076 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
9077 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
9078 else
9079 return attribute_names[0];
9080 }
9081
9082 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
9083
9084 static LONGEST
9085 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
9086 {
9087 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
9088 struct type *type = value_type (val);
9089 LONGEST result;
9090
9091 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9092 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
9093
9094 if (!discrete_position (type, value_as_long (val), &result))
9095 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
9096
9097 return result;
9098 }
9099
9100 static struct value *
9101 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9102 {
9103 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
9104 }
9105
9106 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
9107
9108 static struct value *
9109 val_atr (struct type *type, LONGEST val)
9110 {
9111 gdb_assert (discrete_type_p (type));
9112 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9113 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9114 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
9115 {
9116 if (val < 0 || val >= type->num_fields ())
9117 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
9118 val = TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, val);
9119 }
9120 return value_from_longest (type, val);
9121 }
9122
9123 static struct value *
9124 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9125 {
9126 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9127 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
9128 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
9129 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
9130
9131 return val_atr (type, value_as_long (arg));
9132 }
9133 \f
9134
9135 /* Evaluation */
9136
9137 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
9138 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
9139 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
9140
9141 bool
9142 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
9143 {
9144 const char *name;
9145
9146 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
9147 and don't check any further. */
9148 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
9149 return true;
9150
9151 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
9152 with a known character type name. */
9153 name = ada_type_name (type);
9154 return (name != NULL
9155 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT
9156 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9157 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
9158 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
9159 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
9160 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
9161 }
9162
9163 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
9164
9165 bool
9166 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
9167 {
9168 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9169 if (type != NULL
9170 && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR
9171 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
9172 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9173 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
9174 {
9175 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
9176
9177 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
9178 }
9179 else
9180 return false;
9181 }
9182
9183 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given
9184 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly,
9185 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset
9186 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case
9187 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around
9188 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead.
9189
9190 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types.
9191 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */
9192 static bool trust_pad_over_xvs = true;
9193
9194 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
9195 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
9196 distinctive name. */
9197
9198 int
9199 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
9200 {
9201 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9202
9203 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
9204 return 0;
9205
9206 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9207 && type->num_fields () == 1
9208 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
9209 }
9210
9211 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
9212 the parallel type. */
9213
9214 struct type *
9215 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
9216 {
9217 struct type *real_type_namer;
9218 struct type *raw_real_type;
9219
9220 if (raw_type == NULL || raw_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9221 return raw_type;
9222
9223 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
9224 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
9225 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
9226 simply ignore it.
9227
9228 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
9229 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
9230 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
9231 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
9232 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
9233 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
9234 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
9235 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
9236 return raw_type;
9237
9238 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
9239 if (real_type_namer == NULL
9240 || real_type_namer->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9241 || real_type_namer->num_fields () != 1)
9242 return raw_type;
9243
9244 if (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)->code () != TYPE_CODE_REF)
9245 {
9246 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be
9247 looked up by name. We prefer the newer encoding because it is
9248 more efficient. */
9249 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
9250 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
9251 return raw_type;
9252 else
9253 return raw_real_type;
9254 }
9255
9256 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */
9257 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0));
9258 }
9259
9260 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
9261
9262 struct type *
9263 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
9264 {
9265 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9266 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
9267 else
9268 return ada_get_base_type (type);
9269 }
9270
9271
9272 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
9273 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
9274
9275 const gdb_byte *
9276 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
9277 {
9278 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9279 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
9280 valaddr +
9281 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
9282 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
9283 else
9284 return valaddr;
9285 }
9286
9287
9288
9289 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
9290 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
9291 const char *
9292 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
9293 {
9294 static char *result;
9295 static size_t result_len = 0;
9296 const char *tmp;
9297
9298 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
9299 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
9300 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts
9301 right after that dot.
9302 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
9303 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
9304 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
9305 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
9306
9307 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
9308 if (tmp != NULL)
9309 name = tmp + 1;
9310 else
9311 {
9312 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
9313 {
9314 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
9315 break;
9316 else
9317 name = tmp + 2;
9318 }
9319 }
9320
9321 if (name[0] == 'Q')
9322 {
9323 int v;
9324
9325 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
9326 {
9327 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
9328 return name;
9329 }
9330 else if (((name[1] >= '0' && name[1] <= '9')
9331 || (name[1] >= 'a' && name[1] <= 'z'))
9332 && name[2] == '\0')
9333 {
9334 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 4);
9335 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", name[1]);
9336 return result;
9337 }
9338 else
9339 return name;
9340
9341 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
9342 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
9343 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
9344 else if (name[1] == 'U')
9345 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
9346 else
9347 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
9348
9349 return result;
9350 }
9351 else
9352 {
9353 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
9354 if (tmp == NULL)
9355 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
9356 if (tmp != NULL)
9357 {
9358 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
9359 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
9360 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
9361 return result;
9362 }
9363
9364 return name;
9365 }
9366 }
9367
9368 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
9369 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
9370 expression. */
9371
9372 static struct value *
9373 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9374 {
9375 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
9376 }
9377
9378 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
9379 value it wraps. */
9380
9381 static struct value *
9382 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
9383 {
9384 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
9385
9386 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9387 {
9388 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
9389 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
9390
9391 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
9392 val_type->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
9393
9394 return unwrap_value (v);
9395 }
9396 else
9397 {
9398 struct type *raw_real_type =
9399 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
9400
9401 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is
9402 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */
9403 if ((type == raw_real_type)
9404 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL)
9405 return val;
9406
9407 return
9408 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
9409 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
9410 value_address (val),
9411 NULL, 1));
9412 }
9413 }
9414
9415 static struct value *
9416 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9417 {
9418 struct value *scale = ada_scaling_factor (value_type (arg));
9419 arg = value_cast (value_type (scale), arg);
9420
9421 arg = value_binop (arg, scale, BINOP_MUL);
9422 return value_cast (type, arg);
9423 }
9424
9425 static struct value *
9426 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9427 {
9428 if (type == value_type (arg))
9429 return arg;
9430
9431 struct value *scale = ada_scaling_factor (type);
9432 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
9433 arg = cast_from_fixed (value_type (scale), arg);
9434 else
9435 arg = value_cast (value_type (scale), arg);
9436
9437 arg = value_binop (arg, scale, BINOP_DIV);
9438 return value_cast (type, arg);
9439 }
9440
9441 /* Given two array types T1 and T2, return nonzero iff both arrays
9442 contain the same number of elements. */
9443
9444 static int
9445 ada_same_array_size_p (struct type *t1, struct type *t2)
9446 {
9447 LONGEST lo1, hi1, lo2, hi2;
9448
9449 /* Get the array bounds in order to verify that the size of
9450 the two arrays match. */
9451 if (!get_array_bounds (t1, &lo1, &hi1)
9452 || !get_array_bounds (t2, &lo2, &hi2))
9453 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9454
9455 /* To make things easier for size comparison, normalize a bit
9456 the case of empty arrays by making sure that the difference
9457 between upper bound and lower bound is always -1. */
9458 if (lo1 > hi1)
9459 hi1 = lo1 - 1;
9460 if (lo2 > hi2)
9461 hi2 = lo2 - 1;
9462
9463 return (hi1 - lo1 == hi2 - lo2);
9464 }
9465
9466 /* Assuming that VAL is an array of integrals, and TYPE represents
9467 an array with the same number of elements, but with wider integral
9468 elements, return an array "casted" to TYPE. In practice, this
9469 means that the returned array is built by casting each element
9470 of the original array into TYPE's (wider) element type. */
9471
9472 static struct value *
9473 ada_promote_array_of_integrals (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9474 {
9475 struct type *elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9476 LONGEST lo, hi;
9477 struct value *res;
9478 LONGEST i;
9479
9480 /* Verify that both val and type are arrays of scalars, and
9481 that the size of val's elements is smaller than the size
9482 of type's element. */
9483 gdb_assert (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9484 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
9485 gdb_assert (value_type (val)->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9486 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9487 gdb_assert (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9488 > TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9489
9490 if (!get_array_bounds (type, &lo, &hi))
9491 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9492
9493 res = allocate_value (type);
9494
9495 /* Promote each array element. */
9496 for (i = 0; i < hi - lo + 1; i++)
9497 {
9498 struct value *elt = value_cast (elt_type, value_subscript (val, lo + i));
9499
9500 memcpy (value_contents_writeable (res) + (i * TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type)),
9501 value_contents_all (elt), TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type));
9502 }
9503
9504 return res;
9505 }
9506
9507 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
9508 return the converted value. */
9509
9510 static struct value *
9511 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9512 {
9513 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
9514
9515 if (type == type2)
9516 return val;
9517
9518 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
9519 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9520
9521 if (type2->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9522 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9523 {
9524 val = ada_value_ind (val);
9525 type2 = value_type (val);
9526 }
9527
9528 if (type2->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9529 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9530 {
9531 if (!ada_same_array_size_p (type, type2))
9532 error (_("cannot assign arrays of different length"));
9533
9534 if (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9535 && is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9536 && TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9537 < TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9538 {
9539 /* Allow implicit promotion of the array elements to
9540 a wider type. */
9541 return ada_promote_array_of_integrals (type, val);
9542 }
9543
9544 if (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9545 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9546 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
9547 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
9548 }
9549 return val;
9550 }
9551
9552 static struct value *
9553 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
9554 {
9555 struct value *val;
9556 struct type *type1, *type2;
9557 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
9558
9559 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
9560 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
9561 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
9562 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
9563
9564 if (type1->code () != TYPE_CODE_INT
9565 || type2->code () != TYPE_CODE_INT)
9566 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9567
9568 switch (op)
9569 {
9570 case BINOP_MOD:
9571 case BINOP_DIV:
9572 case BINOP_REM:
9573 break;
9574 default:
9575 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9576 }
9577
9578 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
9579 if (v2 == 0)
9580 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
9581
9582 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
9583 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9584
9585 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
9586 switch (op)
9587 {
9588 case BINOP_DIV:
9589 v = v1 / v2;
9590 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
9591 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
9592 break;
9593 case BINOP_REM:
9594 v = v1 % v2;
9595 if (v * v1 < 0)
9596 v -= v2;
9597 break;
9598 default:
9599 /* Should not reach this point. */
9600 v = 0;
9601 }
9602
9603 val = allocate_value (type1);
9604 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
9605 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
9606 type_byte_order (type1), v);
9607 return val;
9608 }
9609
9610 static int
9611 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
9612 {
9613 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
9614 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
9615 {
9616 struct type *arg1_type, *arg2_type;
9617
9618 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
9619 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
9620 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9621 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
9622
9623 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9624 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
9625
9626 arg1_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9627 arg2_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2));
9628
9629 if (arg1_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9630 || arg2_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9631 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
9632 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
9633 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
9634 and do not have user-defined equality. */
9635 return (TYPE_LENGTH (arg1_type) == TYPE_LENGTH (arg2_type)
9636 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
9637 TYPE_LENGTH (arg1_type)) == 0);
9638 }
9639 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9640 }
9641
9642 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
9643 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
9644 OP_AGGREGATE. */
9645
9646 static int
9647 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
9648 {
9649 int n, m, i;
9650
9651 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9652 pc += 3;
9653 n = 0;
9654 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
9655 {
9656 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
9657 {
9658 default:
9659 n += 1;
9660 break;
9661 case OP_CHOICES:
9662 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9663 break;
9664 }
9665 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
9666 }
9667 return n;
9668 }
9669
9670 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
9671 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
9672 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
9673 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
9674 LHS == CONTAINER). */
9675
9676 static void
9677 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
9678 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9679 {
9680 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
9681 struct value *elt;
9682 struct type *lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9683
9684 if (lhs_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9685 {
9686 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9687 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
9688
9689 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
9690 }
9691 else
9692 {
9693 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
9694 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (elt);
9695 }
9696
9697 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9698 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9699 else
9700 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
9701 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9702 EVAL_NORMAL));
9703
9704 value_free_to_mark (mark);
9705 }
9706
9707 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
9708 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
9709 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
9710 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
9711 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
9712 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
9713 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
9714
9715 static struct value *
9716 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
9717 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9718 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9719 {
9720 struct type *lhs_type;
9721 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
9722 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
9723 int num_specs;
9724 LONGEST *indices;
9725 int max_indices, num_indices;
9726 int i;
9727
9728 *pos += 3;
9729 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
9730 {
9731 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9732 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9733 return container;
9734 }
9735
9736 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
9737 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
9738 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
9739 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
9740 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
9741 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
9742
9743 lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9744 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
9745 {
9746 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
9747 lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9748 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9749 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9750 }
9751 else if (lhs_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9752 {
9753 low_index = 0;
9754 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
9755 }
9756 else
9757 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
9758
9759 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
9760 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
9761 indices = XALLOCAVEC (LONGEST, max_indices);
9762 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
9763 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
9764 num_indices = 4;
9765
9766 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9767 {
9768 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
9769 {
9770 case OP_CHOICES:
9771 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9772 &num_indices, max_indices,
9773 low_index, high_index);
9774 break;
9775 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9776 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9777 &num_indices, max_indices,
9778 low_index, high_index);
9779 break;
9780 case OP_OTHERS:
9781 if (i != n-1)
9782 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
9783 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9784 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
9785 break;
9786 default:
9787 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
9788 }
9789 }
9790
9791 return container;
9792 }
9793
9794 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
9795 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9796 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
9797 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
9798 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
9799 assign_aggregate. */
9800 static void
9801 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
9802 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9803 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9804 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9805 {
9806 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
9807
9808 if (ind - 1 == high)
9809 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
9810 if (ind <= high)
9811 {
9812 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
9813 *pos += 3;
9814 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
9815 }
9816 else
9817 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9818 }
9819
9820 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
9821 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9822 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
9823 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
9824 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9825 static void
9826 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
9827 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9828 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9829 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9830 {
9831 int j;
9832 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
9833 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
9834 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
9835
9836 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
9837
9838 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9839 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9840 expr_pc = *pos;
9841 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9842
9843 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9844 {
9845 LONGEST lower, upper;
9846 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
9847
9848 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
9849 {
9850 choice_pos += 1;
9851 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9852 EVAL_NORMAL));
9853 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9854 EVAL_NORMAL));
9855 }
9856 else if (is_array)
9857 {
9858 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
9859 EVAL_NORMAL));
9860 upper = lower;
9861 }
9862 else
9863 {
9864 int ind;
9865 const char *name;
9866
9867 switch (op)
9868 {
9869 case OP_NAME:
9870 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
9871 break;
9872 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9873 name = exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol->natural_name ();
9874 break;
9875 default:
9876 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
9877 }
9878 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9879 ind = 0;
9880 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
9881 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
9882 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
9883 lower = upper = ind;
9884 }
9885
9886 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
9887 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
9888
9889 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
9890 max_indices);
9891 while (lower <= upper)
9892 {
9893 int pos1;
9894
9895 pos1 = expr_pc;
9896 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
9897 lower += 1;
9898 }
9899 }
9900 }
9901
9902 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
9903 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
9904 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
9905 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
9906 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9907 static void
9908 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
9909 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9910 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
9911 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9912 {
9913 int i;
9914 int expr_pc = *pos + 1;
9915
9916 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
9917 {
9918 LONGEST ind;
9919
9920 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
9921 {
9922 int localpos;
9923
9924 localpos = expr_pc;
9925 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos);
9926 }
9927 }
9928 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9929 }
9930
9931 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
9932 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
9933 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
9934 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
9935 static void
9936 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
9937 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
9938 {
9939 int i, j;
9940
9941 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
9942 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
9943 {
9944 int kh;
9945
9946 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
9947 if (high < indices[kh])
9948 break;
9949 if (low < indices[i])
9950 indices[i] = low;
9951 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
9952 if (high > indices[i + 1])
9953 indices[i + 1] = high;
9954 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
9955 *size -= kh - i - 2;
9956 return;
9957 }
9958 else if (high < indices[i])
9959 break;
9960 }
9961
9962 if (*size == max_size)
9963 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
9964 *size += 2;
9965 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
9966 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
9967 indices[i] = low;
9968 indices[i + 1] = high;
9969 }
9970
9971 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
9972 is different. */
9973
9974 static struct value *
9975 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2)
9976 {
9977 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
9978 return arg2;
9979
9980 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (type))
9981 return cast_to_fixed (type, arg2);
9982
9983 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9984 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
9985
9986 return value_cast (type, arg2);
9987 }
9988
9989 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
9990 ------------------------------------------------------
9991
9992 1. Introduction:
9993 ----------------
9994
9995 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
9996 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
9997 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
9998 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
9999 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
10000 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
10001 similar.
10002
10003 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
10004 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
10005 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
10006 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
10007 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
10008
10009 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
10010 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
10011 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
10012 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
10013 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
10014 in the GNAT sources.
10015
10016 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
10017 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
10018 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
10019 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
10020 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
10021 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
10022
10023 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
10024 -----------------------------------------
10025
10026 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
10027 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
10028 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
10029
10030 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
10031 case Empty is
10032 when True => null;
10033 when False => Value : Integer;
10034 end case;
10035 end record;
10036 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
10037 No : Rec := (empty => True);
10038
10039 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
10040 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
10041 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
10042 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
10043 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
10044 We also informally refer to this operation as "fixing" an object,
10045 which means creating its associated fixed type.
10046
10047 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
10048 type would look like this:
10049
10050 type Rec is record
10051 Empty : Boolean;
10052 Value : Integer;
10053 end record;
10054
10055 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
10056 would become:
10057
10058 type Rec is record
10059 Empty : Boolean;
10060 end record;
10061
10062 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
10063 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
10064 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
10065 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
10066
10067 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
10068 ---------------------
10069
10070 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
10071 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
10072 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
10073 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
10074 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
10075 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
10076 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
10077 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
10078 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
10079 when (if) necessary.
10080
10081 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
10082 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
10083 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
10084 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
10085
10086 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
10087
10088 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
10089 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
10090 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
10091 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
10092 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
10093 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
10094 the size of each element).
10095
10096 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
10097 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
10098
10099 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
10100 Length : Integer;
10101 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10102 end record;
10103 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
10104
10105 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
10106 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
10107 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
10108
10109 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
10110 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
10111 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
10112 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
10113 these wrapper types.
10114
10115 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
10116 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
10117 and the array element should remain unfixed.
10118
10119 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
10120 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
10121
10122 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
10123 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
10124 Data : Dynamic;
10125 case Has_Length is
10126 when True => Length : Integer;
10127 when False => null;
10128 end case;
10129 end record;
10130 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
10131
10132 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
10133 Data => (others => 17),
10134 Length => 1));
10135
10136
10137 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
10138 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
10139 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
10140 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
10141 be used for the fixed array.
10142
10143 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
10144 ----------------------------------
10145
10146 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
10147 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
10148 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
10149 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
10150 type of each of these components.
10151
10152 Consider for instance the example:
10153
10154 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
10155 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10156 Length : Natural;
10157 end record;
10158 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
10159
10160 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
10161 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
10162 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
10163 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
10164 record requires us to fix each of its components.
10165
10166 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
10167 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
10168 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
10169 (assuming type Rec above):
10170
10171 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
10172 First : Rec;
10173 After : Integer;
10174 case Big is
10175 when True => Another : Integer;
10176 when False => null;
10177 end case;
10178 end record;
10179 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
10180 First => (Empty => True),
10181 After => 42);
10182
10183 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
10184 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
10185 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
10186 in this case.
10187
10188 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
10189 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
10190 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
10191 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
10192 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
10193 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
10194 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
10195 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
10196 compute the wrong offset of field After.
10197
10198 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
10199 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
10200 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
10201 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
10202 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
10203 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
10204 observed with the following type declarations:
10205
10206 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
10207 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
10208 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
10209
10210 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
10211 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
10212 Length : Integer;
10213 end record;
10214
10215 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
10216 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
10217
10218 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
10219 ----------------------------------------------------------
10220
10221 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
10222 thus far, be actually fixed?
10223
10224 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
10225 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
10226 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
10227 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
10228 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
10229 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
10230 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
10231 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
10232
10233 Note that one of the side effects of miscomputing the offset and
10234 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
10235 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
10236 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
10237 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
10238 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
10239 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
10240 entity. Results in this case are unpredictable, as we usually read
10241 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
10242
10243 /* Evaluate a subexpression of EXP, at index *POS, and return a value
10244 for that subexpression cast to TO_TYPE. Advance *POS over the
10245 subexpression. */
10246
10247 static value *
10248 ada_evaluate_subexp_for_cast (expression *exp, int *pos,
10249 enum noside noside, struct type *to_type)
10250 {
10251 int pc = *pos;
10252
10253 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE
10254 || exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE)
10255 {
10256 (*pos) += 4;
10257
10258 value *val;
10259 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE)
10260 {
10261 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10262 return value_zero (to_type, not_lval);
10263
10264 val = evaluate_var_msym_value (noside,
10265 exp->elts[pc + 1].objfile,
10266 exp->elts[pc + 2].msymbol);
10267 }
10268 else
10269 val = evaluate_var_value (noside,
10270 exp->elts[pc + 1].block,
10271 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol);
10272
10273 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10274 return eval_skip_value (exp);
10275
10276 val = ada_value_cast (to_type, val);
10277
10278 /* Follow the Ada language semantics that do not allow taking
10279 an address of the result of a cast (view conversion in Ada). */
10280 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_memory)
10281 {
10282 if (value_lazy (val))
10283 value_fetch_lazy (val);
10284 VALUE_LVAL (val) = not_lval;
10285 }
10286 return val;
10287 }
10288
10289 value *val = evaluate_subexp (to_type, exp, pos, noside);
10290 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10291 return eval_skip_value (exp);
10292 return ada_value_cast (to_type, val);
10293 }
10294
10295 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
10296 for the Ada language. */
10297
10298 static struct value *
10299 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
10300 int *pos, enum noside noside)
10301 {
10302 enum exp_opcode op;
10303 int tem;
10304 int pc;
10305 int preeval_pos;
10306 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
10307 struct type *type;
10308 int nargs, oplen;
10309 struct value **argvec;
10310
10311 pc = *pos;
10312 *pos += 1;
10313 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
10314
10315 switch (op)
10316 {
10317 default:
10318 *pos -= 1;
10319 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10320
10321 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
10322 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
10323
10324 /* If evaluating an OP_FLOAT and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
10325 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
10326 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
10327 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
10328 types in Ada have different representations.
10329
10330 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
10331 ourselves. */
10332 if ((op == OP_FLOAT || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
10333 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1);
10334
10335 return arg1;
10336
10337 case OP_STRING:
10338 {
10339 struct value *result;
10340
10341 *pos -= 1;
10342 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10343 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
10344 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
10345 if (value_type (result)->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
10346 value_type (result)->set_code (TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
10347 return result;
10348 }
10349
10350 case UNOP_CAST:
10351 (*pos) += 2;
10352 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10353 return ada_evaluate_subexp_for_cast (exp, pos, noside, type);
10354
10355 case UNOP_QUAL:
10356 (*pos) += 2;
10357 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10358 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10359
10360 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
10361 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10362 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
10363 {
10364 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
10365 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10366 return arg1;
10367 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
10368 }
10369 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
10370 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
10371 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
10372 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
10373 type = value_type (arg1);
10374 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
10375 type = NULL;
10376 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10377 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10378 return arg1;
10379 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
10380 {
10381 /* Nothing. */
10382 }
10383 else if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10384 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10385 else if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10386 error
10387 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
10388 else
10389 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10390 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
10391
10392 case BINOP_ADD:
10393 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10394 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10395 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10396 goto nosideret;
10397 if (value_type (arg1)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10398 return (value_from_longest
10399 (value_type (arg1),
10400 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10401 if (value_type (arg2)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10402 return (value_from_longest
10403 (value_type (arg2),
10404 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10405 if ((ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10406 || ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10407 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10408 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
10409 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
10410 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10411 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10412 type = value_type (arg1);
10413 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10414 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10415 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10416 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
10417
10418 case BINOP_SUB:
10419 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10420 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10421 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10422 goto nosideret;
10423 if (value_type (arg1)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10424 return (value_from_longest
10425 (value_type (arg1),
10426 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10427 if (value_type (arg2)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10428 return (value_from_longest
10429 (value_type (arg2),
10430 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10431 if ((ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10432 || ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10433 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10434 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction "
10435 "must have the same type"));
10436 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
10437 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10438 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10439 type = value_type (arg1);
10440 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10441 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10442 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10443 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
10444
10445 case BINOP_MUL:
10446 case BINOP_DIV:
10447 case BINOP_REM:
10448 case BINOP_MOD:
10449 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10450 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10451 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10452 goto nosideret;
10453 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10454 {
10455 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10456 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10457 }
10458 else
10459 {
10460 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
10461 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10462 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
10463 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10464 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
10465 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10466 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
10467 }
10468
10469 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10470 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10471 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10472 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
10473 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10474 goto nosideret;
10475 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10476 tem = 0;
10477 else
10478 {
10479 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10480 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
10481 }
10482 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
10483 tem = !tem;
10484 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10485 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
10486
10487 case UNOP_NEG:
10488 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10489 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10490 goto nosideret;
10491 else if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10492 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
10493 else
10494 {
10495 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10496 return value_neg (arg1);
10497 }
10498
10499 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10500 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10501 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10502 {
10503 struct value *val;
10504
10505 *pos -= 1;
10506 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10507 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10508 return value_cast (type, val);
10509 }
10510
10511 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10512 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10513 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10514 {
10515 struct value *val;
10516
10517 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
10518 *pos = pc;
10519 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10520
10521 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
10522 }
10523
10524 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10525 *pos -= 1;
10526
10527 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10528 {
10529 *pos += 4;
10530 goto nosideret;
10531 }
10532
10533 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10534 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
10535 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
10536 invalid. */
10537 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10538 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
10539
10540 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10541 {
10542 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
10543 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
10544 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
10545 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
10546 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
10547 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
10548 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0)
10549 || (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
10550 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)))
10551 {
10552 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
10553 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
10554 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
10555 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
10556 type from its tag.
10557
10558 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
10559 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
10560 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
10561 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
10562 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
10563 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
10564 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
10565 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
10566 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
10567 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
10568 type in the type description. */
10569 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
10570
10571 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_REF)
10572 {
10573 struct type *actual_type;
10574
10575 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
10576 if (actual_type == NULL)
10577 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
10578 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
10579 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
10580 This can happen if the debugging information is
10581 incomplete, for instance. */
10582 actual_type = type;
10583 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
10584 }
10585 else
10586 {
10587 /* In the case of a ref, ada_coerce_ref takes care
10588 of determining the actual type. But the evaluation
10589 should return a ref as it should be valid to ask
10590 for its address; so rebuild a ref after coerce. */
10591 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
10592 return value_ref (arg1, TYPE_CODE_REF);
10593 }
10594 }
10595
10596 /* Records and unions for which GNAT encodings have been
10597 generated need to be statically fixed as well.
10598 Otherwise, non-static fixing produces a type where
10599 all dynamic properties are removed, which prevents "ptype"
10600 from being able to completely describe the type.
10601 For instance, a case statement in a variant record would be
10602 replaced by the relevant components based on the actual
10603 value of the discriminants. */
10604 if ((type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10605 && dynamic_template_type (type) != NULL)
10606 || (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_UNION
10607 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVU") != NULL))
10608 {
10609 *pos += 4;
10610 return value_zero (to_static_fixed_type (type), not_lval);
10611 }
10612 }
10613
10614 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10615 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
10616
10617 case OP_FUNCALL:
10618 (*pos) += 2;
10619
10620 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
10621 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
10622 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10623 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 2);
10624
10625 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
10626 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10627 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10628 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->print_name ());
10629 else
10630 {
10631 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
10632 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10633 argvec[tem] = 0;
10634
10635 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10636 goto nosideret;
10637 }
10638
10639 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
10640 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
10641 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
10642 else if (value_type (argvec[0])->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10643 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
10644 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
10645 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
10646 to do. */
10647 ;
10648 else if (value_type (argvec[0])->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10649 {
10650 /* Make sure we dereference references so that all the code below
10651 feels like it's really handling the referenced value. Wrapping
10652 types (for alignment) may be there, so make sure we strip them as
10653 well. */
10654 argvec[0] = ada_to_fixed_value (coerce_ref (argvec[0]));
10655 }
10656 else if (value_type (argvec[0])->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10657 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory)
10658 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
10659
10660 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
10661
10662 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting
10663 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array
10664 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */
10665 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
10666 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
10667
10668 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10669 {
10670 switch (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))->code ())
10671 {
10672 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10673 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10674 break;
10675 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10676 break;
10677 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10678 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10679 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
10680 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10681 break;
10682 default:
10683 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
10684 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
10685 break;
10686 }
10687 }
10688
10689 switch (type->code ())
10690 {
10691 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10692 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10693 {
10694 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
10695 error_call_unknown_return_type (NULL);
10696 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10697 }
10698 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], NULL,
10699 gdb::make_array_view (argvec + 1,
10700 nargs));
10701 case TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION:
10702 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10703 /* We don't know anything about what the internal
10704 function might return, but we have to return
10705 something. */
10706 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10707 not_lval);
10708 else
10709 return call_internal_function (exp->gdbarch, exp->language_defn,
10710 argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
10711
10712 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10713 {
10714 int arity;
10715
10716 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
10717 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10718 if (type == NULL)
10719 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
10720 if (arity != nargs)
10721 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
10722 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10723 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10724 return
10725 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10726 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
10727 }
10728 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10729 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10730 {
10731 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10732 if (type == NULL)
10733 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10734 else
10735 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10736 }
10737 return
10738 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10739 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
10740 nargs, argvec + 1));
10741 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
10742 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10743 {
10744 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
10745 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10746 if (type == NULL)
10747 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10748 else
10749 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10750 }
10751 return
10752 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0],
10753 nargs, argvec + 1));
10754
10755 default:
10756 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
10757 "array or function"));
10758 }
10759
10760 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10761 {
10762 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10763 struct value *low_bound_val =
10764 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10765 struct value *high_bound_val =
10766 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10767 LONGEST low_bound;
10768 LONGEST high_bound;
10769
10770 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
10771 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
10772 low_bound = value_as_long (low_bound_val);
10773 high_bound = value_as_long (high_bound_val);
10774
10775 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10776 goto nosideret;
10777
10778 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
10779 the aligners. */
10780 if (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
10781 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
10782 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
10783 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
10784
10785 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
10786 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
10787
10788 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
10789 convert to a pointer. */
10790 if (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
10791 || (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10792 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
10793 array = value_addr (array);
10794
10795 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
10796 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
10797 (value_type (array))))
10798 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound,
10799 high_bound);
10800
10801 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
10802
10803 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
10804 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
10805 while (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10806 && (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))->code ()
10807 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
10808 array = value_ind (array);
10809
10810 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
10811 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
10812 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
10813 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
10814 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
10815 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
10816
10817 if (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array))->code ()
10818 == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10819 {
10820 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
10821
10822 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10823 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound, high_bound);
10824 else
10825 {
10826 struct type *arr_type0 =
10827 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1);
10828
10829 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
10830 longest_to_int (low_bound),
10831 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10832 }
10833 }
10834 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10835 return array;
10836 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
10837 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound, high_bound);
10838 else
10839 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
10840 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10841 }
10842
10843 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10844 (*pos) += 2;
10845 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10846 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10847
10848 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10849 goto nosideret;
10850
10851 switch (type->code ())
10852 {
10853 default:
10854 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
10855 "always returns true"));
10856 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10857 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
10858
10859 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
10860 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
10861 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
10862 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10863 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10864 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10865 return
10866 value_from_longest (type,
10867 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10868 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10869 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10870 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10871 }
10872
10873 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10874 (*pos) += 2;
10875 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10876 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10877
10878 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10879 goto nosideret;
10880
10881 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10882 {
10883 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10884 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10885 }
10886
10887 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10888
10889 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
10890 if (!type)
10891 type = value_type (arg1);
10892
10893 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
10894 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
10895
10896 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10897 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10898 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10899 return
10900 value_from_longest (type,
10901 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10902 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10903 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10904 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10905
10906 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10907 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10908 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10909 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10910
10911 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10912 goto nosideret;
10913
10914 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10915 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10916 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10917 return
10918 value_from_longest (type,
10919 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10920 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10921 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10922 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10923
10924 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10925 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10926 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10927 {
10928 struct type *type_arg;
10929
10930 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
10931 {
10932 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10933 arg1 = NULL;
10934 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10935 }
10936 else
10937 {
10938 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10939 type_arg = NULL;
10940 }
10941
10942 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
10943 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
10944 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
10945 *pos += 4;
10946
10947 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10948 goto nosideret;
10949 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10950 {
10951 if (type_arg == NULL)
10952 type_arg = value_type (arg1);
10953
10954 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
10955 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
10956
10957 if (!discrete_type_p (type_arg))
10958 {
10959 switch (op)
10960 {
10961 default: /* Should never happen. */
10962 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10963 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10964 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10965 type_arg = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem,
10966 ada_attribute_name (op));
10967 break;
10968 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10969 type_arg = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10970 break;
10971 }
10972 }
10973
10974 return value_zero (type_arg, not_lval);
10975 }
10976 else if (type_arg == NULL)
10977 {
10978 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
10979
10980 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
10981 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
10982
10983 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
10984 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10985 else
10986 {
10987 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
10988 ada_attribute_name (op));
10989 if (type == NULL)
10990 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10991 }
10992
10993 switch (op)
10994 {
10995 default: /* Should never happen. */
10996 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10997 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10998 return value_from_longest
10999 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
11000 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11001 return value_from_longest
11002 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
11003 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11004 return value_from_longest
11005 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
11006 }
11007 }
11008 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
11009 {
11010 struct type *range_type;
11011 const char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
11012
11013 range_type = NULL;
11014 if (name != NULL && type_arg->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
11015 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL);
11016 if (range_type == NULL)
11017 range_type = type_arg;
11018 switch (op)
11019 {
11020 default:
11021 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11022 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11023 return value_from_longest
11024 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
11025 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11026 return value_from_longest
11027 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
11028 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11029 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
11030 }
11031 }
11032 else if (type_arg->code () == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
11033 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
11034 else
11035 {
11036 LONGEST low, high;
11037
11038 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
11039 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
11040
11041 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
11042 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11043 else
11044 {
11045 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
11046 if (type == NULL)
11047 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11048 }
11049
11050 switch (op)
11051 {
11052 default:
11053 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11054 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11055 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
11056 return value_from_longest (type, low);
11057 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11058 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
11059 return value_from_longest (type, high);
11060 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11061 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
11062 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
11063 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
11064 }
11065 }
11066 }
11067
11068 case OP_ATR_TAG:
11069 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11070 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11071 goto nosideret;
11072
11073 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11074 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
11075
11076 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
11077
11078 case OP_ATR_MIN:
11079 case OP_ATR_MAX:
11080 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11081 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11082 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11083 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11084 goto nosideret;
11085 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11086 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
11087 else
11088 {
11089 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
11090 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
11091 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
11092 }
11093
11094 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
11095 {
11096 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
11097
11098 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11099 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11100 goto nosideret;
11101
11102 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
11103 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
11104
11105 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
11106 ada_modulus (type_arg));
11107 }
11108
11109
11110 case OP_ATR_POS:
11111 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11112 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11113 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11114 goto nosideret;
11115 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11116 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11117 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
11118 else
11119 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
11120
11121 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
11122 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11123 type = value_type (arg1);
11124
11125 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
11126 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
11127 not the size of the pointer. */
11128 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
11129 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
11130
11131 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11132 goto nosideret;
11133 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11134 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
11135 else
11136 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11137 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
11138
11139 case OP_ATR_VAL:
11140 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11141 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11142 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
11143 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11144 goto nosideret;
11145 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11146 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
11147 else
11148 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
11149
11150 case BINOP_EXP:
11151 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11152 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11153 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11154 goto nosideret;
11155 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11156 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
11157 else
11158 {
11159 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
11160 only promote the first argument. */
11161 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
11162 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11163 else
11164 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
11165
11166 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
11167 }
11168
11169 case UNOP_PLUS:
11170 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11171 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11172 goto nosideret;
11173 else
11174 return arg1;
11175
11176 case UNOP_ABS:
11177 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11178 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11179 goto nosideret;
11180 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11181 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
11182 return value_neg (arg1);
11183 else
11184 return arg1;
11185
11186 case UNOP_IND:
11187 preeval_pos = *pos;
11188 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11189 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11190 goto nosideret;
11191 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11192 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11193 {
11194 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11195 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11196 {
11197 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
11198
11199 if (arrType == NULL)
11200 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
11201 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
11202 }
11203 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
11204 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
11205 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
11206 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
11207 {
11208 /* As mentioned in the OP_VAR_VALUE case, tagged types can
11209 only be determined by inspecting the object's tag.
11210 This means that we need to evaluate completely the
11211 expression in order to get its type. */
11212
11213 if ((type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
11214 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
11215 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0))
11216 {
11217 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11218 EVAL_NORMAL);
11219 type = value_type (ada_value_ind (arg1));
11220 }
11221 else
11222 {
11223 type = to_static_fixed_type
11224 (ada_aligned_type
11225 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
11226 }
11227 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
11228 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
11229 }
11230 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11231 {
11232 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
11233 if (expect_type == NULL)
11234 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11235 lval_memory);
11236 else
11237 {
11238 expect_type =
11239 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
11240 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
11241 }
11242 }
11243 else
11244 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
11245 }
11246 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
11247 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11248
11249 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11250 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
11251 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
11252 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
11253 {
11254 if (expect_type != NULL)
11255 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
11256 arg1));
11257 else
11258 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11259 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
11260 }
11261
11262 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11263 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11264 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
11265 else
11266 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
11267
11268 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
11269 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11270 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
11271 preeval_pos = *pos;
11272 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11273 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11274 goto nosideret;
11275 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11276 {
11277 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
11278
11279 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
11280 {
11281 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
11282 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11283 1, 1);
11284
11285 /* If the field is not found, check if it exists in the
11286 extension of this object's type. This means that we
11287 need to evaluate completely the expression. */
11288
11289 if (type == NULL)
11290 {
11291 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11292 EVAL_NORMAL);
11293 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1,
11294 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11295 0);
11296 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11297 type = value_type (ada_to_fixed_value (arg1));
11298 }
11299 }
11300 else
11301 type =
11302 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
11303 0);
11304
11305 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
11306 }
11307 else
11308 {
11309 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
11310 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11311 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
11312 }
11313
11314 case OP_TYPE:
11315 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
11316 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
11317 (*pos) += 2;
11318 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11319 goto nosideret;
11320 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11321 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
11322 else
11323 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
11324
11325 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11326 case OP_CHOICES:
11327 case OP_OTHERS:
11328 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11329 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11330 case OP_NAME:
11331 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
11332 switch (op)
11333 {
11334 case OP_NAME:
11335 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
11336 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
11337 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11338 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
11339 default:
11340 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11341 _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
11342 }
11343
11344 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
11345 *pos += oplen - 1;
11346 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
11347 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
11348 goto nosideret;
11349 }
11350
11351 nosideret:
11352 return eval_skip_value (exp);
11353 }
11354 \f
11355
11356 /* Fixed point */
11357
11358 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
11359 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
11360 Otherwise, return NULL. */
11361
11362 static const char *
11363 gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
11364 {
11365 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
11366 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : type->code ();
11367
11368 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
11369 {
11370 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
11371
11372 if (tail == NULL)
11373 return NULL;
11374 else
11375 return tail + 5;
11376 }
11377 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
11378 return gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
11379 else
11380 return NULL;
11381 }
11382
11383 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
11384
11385 int
11386 ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
11387 {
11388 return gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
11389 }
11390
11391 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
11392
11393 int
11394 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
11395 {
11396 return (type->name () && strcmp (type->name (), "system__address") == 0);
11397 }
11398
11399 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
11400 type, return the target floating-point type to be used to represent
11401 of this type during internal computation. */
11402
11403 static struct type *
11404 ada_scaling_type (struct type *type)
11405 {
11406 return builtin_type (get_type_arch (type))->builtin_long_double;
11407 }
11408
11409 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
11410 type, return its delta, or NULL if the type is malformed and the
11411 delta cannot be determined. */
11412
11413 struct value *
11414 gnat_encoded_fixed_point_delta (struct type *type)
11415 {
11416 const char *encoding = gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (type);
11417 struct type *scale_type = ada_scaling_type (type);
11418
11419 long long num, den;
11420
11421 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%lld_%lld", &num, &den) < 2)
11422 return nullptr;
11423 else
11424 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num),
11425 value_from_longest (scale_type, den), BINOP_DIV);
11426 }
11427
11428 /* Assuming that ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return
11429 the scaling factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
11430
11431 struct value *
11432 ada_scaling_factor (struct type *type)
11433 {
11434 const char *encoding = gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (type);
11435 struct type *scale_type = ada_scaling_type (type);
11436
11437 long long num0, den0, num1, den1;
11438 int n;
11439
11440 n = sscanf (encoding, "_%lld_%lld_%lld_%lld",
11441 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
11442
11443 if (n < 2)
11444 return value_from_longest (scale_type, 1);
11445 else if (n == 4)
11446 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num1),
11447 value_from_longest (scale_type, den1), BINOP_DIV);
11448 else
11449 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num0),
11450 value_from_longest (scale_type, den0), BINOP_DIV);
11451 }
11452
11453 \f
11454
11455 /* Range types */
11456
11457 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
11458 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
11459 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
11460 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
11461 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
11462
11463 static int
11464 scan_discrim_bound (const char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
11465 int *pnew_k)
11466 {
11467 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
11468 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
11469 const char *pstart, *pend, *bound;
11470 struct value *bound_val;
11471
11472 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
11473 return 0;
11474
11475 pstart = str + k;
11476 pend = strstr (pstart, "__");
11477 if (pend == NULL)
11478 {
11479 bound = pstart;
11480 k += strlen (bound);
11481 }
11482 else
11483 {
11484 int len = pend - pstart;
11485
11486 /* Strip __ and beyond. */
11487 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, len + 1);
11488 strncpy (bound_buffer, pstart, len);
11489 bound_buffer[len] = '\0';
11490
11491 bound = bound_buffer;
11492 k = pend - str;
11493 }
11494
11495 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
11496 if (bound_val == NULL)
11497 return 0;
11498
11499 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
11500 if (pnew_k != NULL)
11501 *pnew_k = k;
11502 return 1;
11503 }
11504
11505 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
11506 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
11507 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
11508
11509 static struct value *
11510 get_var_value (const char *name, const char *err_msg)
11511 {
11512 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
11513
11514 std::vector<struct block_symbol> syms;
11515 int nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (lookup_name,
11516 get_selected_block (0),
11517 VAR_DOMAIN, &syms, 1);
11518
11519 if (nsyms != 1)
11520 {
11521 if (err_msg == NULL)
11522 return 0;
11523 else
11524 error (("%s"), err_msg);
11525 }
11526
11527 return value_of_variable (syms[0].symbol, syms[0].block);
11528 }
11529
11530 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment.
11531 If no such variable is found, returns false. Otherwise, sets VALUE
11532 to the variable's value and returns true. */
11533
11534 bool
11535 get_int_var_value (const char *name, LONGEST &value)
11536 {
11537 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
11538
11539 if (var_val == 0)
11540 return false;
11541
11542 value = value_as_long (var_val);
11543 return true;
11544 }
11545
11546
11547 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
11548 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
11549 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
11550 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
11551 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
11552 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
11553 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
11554 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
11555
11556 static struct type *
11557 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval)
11558 {
11559 const char *name;
11560 struct type *base_type;
11561 const char *subtype_info;
11562
11563 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL);
11564 gdb_assert (raw_type->name () != NULL);
11565
11566 if (raw_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
11567 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
11568 else
11569 base_type = raw_type;
11570
11571 name = raw_type->name ();
11572 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
11573 if (subtype_info == NULL)
11574 {
11575 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
11576 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
11577
11578 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
11579 return raw_type;
11580 else
11581 return create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type,
11582 L, U);
11583 }
11584 else
11585 {
11586 static char *name_buf = NULL;
11587 static size_t name_len = 0;
11588 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
11589 LONGEST L, U;
11590 struct type *type;
11591 const char *bounds_str;
11592 int n;
11593
11594 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
11595 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
11596 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
11597
11598 subtype_info += 5;
11599 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
11600 n = 1;
11601
11602 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
11603 {
11604 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
11605 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
11606 return raw_type;
11607 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
11608 n += 2;
11609 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
11610 n += 1;
11611 subtype_info += 1;
11612 }
11613 else
11614 {
11615 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
11616 if (!get_int_var_value (name_buf, L))
11617 {
11618 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
11619 L = 1;
11620 }
11621 }
11622
11623 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
11624 {
11625 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
11626 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
11627 return raw_type;
11628 }
11629 else
11630 {
11631 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
11632 if (!get_int_var_value (name_buf, U))
11633 {
11634 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
11635 U = L;
11636 }
11637 }
11638
11639 type = create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type),
11640 base_type, L, U);
11641 /* create_static_range_type alters the resulting type's length
11642 to match the size of the base_type, which is not what we want.
11643 Set it back to the original range type's length. */
11644 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = TYPE_LENGTH (raw_type);
11645 type->set_name (name);
11646 return type;
11647 }
11648 }
11649
11650 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
11651
11652 int
11653 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
11654 {
11655 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
11656 }
11657 \f
11658
11659 /* Modular types */
11660
11661 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
11662
11663 int
11664 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
11665 {
11666 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type);
11667
11668 return (subranged_type != NULL && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
11669 && subranged_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT
11670 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
11671 }
11672
11673 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
11674
11675 ULONGEST
11676 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
11677 {
11678 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
11679 }
11680 \f
11681
11682 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
11683 ---------------------------------
11684
11685 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
11686 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
11687 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
11688 . catchpoints on failed assertions
11689
11690 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
11691 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
11692 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
11693 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
11694 to zero-in on certain situations.
11695
11696 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
11697 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
11698 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
11699 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
11700 of breakpoint_ops.
11701
11702 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
11703 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
11704 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
11705 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
11706 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */
11707
11708 /* Ada's standard exceptions.
11709
11710 The Ada 83 standard also defined Numeric_Error. But there so many
11711 situations where it was unclear from the Ada 83 Reference Manual
11712 (RM) whether Constraint_Error or Numeric_Error should be raised,
11713 that the ARG (Ada Rapporteur Group) eventually issued a Binding
11714 Interpretation saying that anytime the RM says that Numeric_Error
11715 should be raised, the implementation may raise Constraint_Error.
11716 Ada 95 went one step further and pretty much removed Numeric_Error
11717 from the list of standard exceptions (it made it a renaming of
11718 Constraint_Error, to help preserve compatibility when compiling
11719 an Ada83 compiler). As such, we do not include Numeric_Error from
11720 this list of standard exceptions. */
11721
11722 static const char *standard_exc[] = {
11723 "constraint_error",
11724 "program_error",
11725 "storage_error",
11726 "tasking_error"
11727 };
11728
11729 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
11730
11731 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
11732 for a given executable. */
11733
11734 struct exception_support_info
11735 {
11736 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11737 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
11738 const char *catch_exception_sym;
11739
11740 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11741 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
11742 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
11743
11744 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11745 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
11746 const char *catch_assert_sym;
11747
11748 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11749 a catchpoint on exception handling. */
11750 const char *catch_handlers_sym;
11751
11752 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
11753 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
11754 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
11755 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
11756 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
11757 };
11758
11759 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
11760 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
11761
11762 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11763 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
11764 Ada runtime (as of 2019-08-??). */
11765
11766 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
11767 {
11768 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11769 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11770 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11771 "__gnat_begin_handler_v1", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11772 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11773 };
11774
11775 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11776 implement exception catchpoints with an earlier version of the
11777 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06) using v0 of the EH ABI. */
11778
11779 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_v0 =
11780 {
11781 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11782 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11783 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11784 "__gnat_begin_handler", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11785 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11786 };
11787
11788 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11789 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
11790 of the Ada runtime. */
11791
11792 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
11793 {
11794 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
11795 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11796 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11797 "__gnat_begin_handler", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11798 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
11799 };
11800
11801 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines
11802 described in EINFO.
11803
11804 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected
11805 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but
11806 that support is found to be incomplete). */
11807
11808 static int
11809 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo)
11810 {
11811 struct symbol *sym;
11812
11813 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
11814 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
11815 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */
11816
11817 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11818 if (sym == NULL)
11819 {
11820 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was
11821 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it.
11822 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where
11823 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get
11824 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user
11825 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint.
11826
11827 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception
11828 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol.
11829 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are
11830 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract
11831 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in
11832 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch
11833 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */
11834 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym
11835 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL);
11836
11837 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11838 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11839 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11840 "in this configuration."));
11841
11842 return 0;
11843 }
11844
11845 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11846
11847 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11848 {
11849 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11850 sym->linkage_name (), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11851 return 0;
11852 }
11853
11854 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_handlers_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11855 if (sym == NULL)
11856 {
11857 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym
11858 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_handlers_sym, NULL, NULL);
11859
11860 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11861 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11862 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11863 "in this configuration."));
11864
11865 return 0;
11866 }
11867
11868 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11869
11870 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11871 {
11872 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11873 sym->linkage_name (), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11874 return 0;
11875 }
11876
11877 return 1;
11878 }
11879
11880 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
11881 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
11882
11883 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info,
11884 or raise an error. */
11885
11886 static void
11887 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
11888 {
11889 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11890
11891 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
11892 if (data->exception_info != NULL)
11893 return;
11894
11895 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
11896 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info))
11897 {
11898 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
11899 return;
11900 }
11901
11902 /* Try the v0 exception suport info. */
11903 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_v0))
11904 {
11905 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_v0;
11906 return;
11907 }
11908
11909 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
11910 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback))
11911 {
11912 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
11913 return;
11914 }
11915
11916 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
11917 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
11918 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
11919 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
11920 applicable. */
11921
11922 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada)
11923 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
11924
11925 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
11926 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
11927 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
11928 in a shared library. */
11929
11930 if (inferior_ptid.pid () == 0)
11931 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
11932
11933 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
11934 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
11935 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
11936 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
11937 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
11938 supporting this feature. */
11939
11940 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration."));
11941 }
11942
11943 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
11944 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
11945 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
11946 to most users. */
11947
11948 static int
11949 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
11950 {
11951 enum language func_lang;
11952 int i;
11953 const char *fullname;
11954
11955 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
11956 This cannot be any user code. */
11957
11958 symtab_and_line sal = find_frame_sal (frame);
11959 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
11960 return 1;
11961
11962 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
11963 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
11964 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
11965 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
11966 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
11967
11968 fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
11969 if (access (fullname, R_OK) != 0)
11970 return 1;
11971
11972 /* Check the unit filename against the Ada runtime file naming.
11973 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
11974 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
11975 too. */
11976
11977 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
11978 {
11979 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
11980 if (re_exec (lbasename (sal.symtab->filename)))
11981 return 1;
11982 if (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab) != NULL
11983 && re_exec (objfile_name (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab))))
11984 return 1;
11985 }
11986
11987 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
11988
11989 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> func_name
11990 = find_frame_funname (frame, &func_lang, NULL);
11991 if (func_name == NULL)
11992 return 1;
11993
11994 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
11995 {
11996 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
11997 if (re_exec (func_name.get ()))
11998 return 1;
11999 }
12000
12001 return 0;
12002 }
12003
12004 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
12005 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
12006
12007 void
12008 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
12009 {
12010 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
12011 {
12012 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
12013 {
12014 select_frame (fi);
12015 break;
12016 }
12017 }
12018
12019 }
12020
12021 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
12022 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
12023 of the exception is stored.
12024
12025 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
12026
12027 static CORE_ADDR
12028 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
12029 {
12030 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
12031 }
12032
12033 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
12034 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
12035 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
12036 several frames up in the callstack. */
12037
12038 static CORE_ADDR
12039 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
12040 {
12041 int frame_level;
12042 struct frame_info *fi;
12043 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12044
12045 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
12046 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
12047 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
12048 without checking the name of their associated function. */
12049 fi = get_current_frame ();
12050 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
12051 if (fi != NULL)
12052 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
12053
12054 while (fi != NULL)
12055 {
12056 enum language func_lang;
12057
12058 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> func_name
12059 = find_frame_funname (fi, &func_lang, NULL);
12060 if (func_name != NULL)
12061 {
12062 if (strcmp (func_name.get (),
12063 data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
12064 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
12065 }
12066 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
12067 }
12068
12069 if (fi == NULL)
12070 return 0;
12071
12072 select_frame (fi);
12073 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
12074 }
12075
12076 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
12077 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
12078 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
12079
12080 Assumes the selected frame is the current frame.
12081
12082 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
12083
12084 static CORE_ADDR
12085 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12086 struct breakpoint *b)
12087 {
12088 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12089
12090 switch (ex)
12091 {
12092 case ada_catch_exception:
12093 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
12094 break;
12095
12096 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12097 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
12098 break;
12099
12100 case ada_catch_handlers:
12101 return 0; /* The runtimes does not provide access to the exception
12102 name. */
12103 break;
12104
12105 case ada_catch_assert:
12106 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
12107 break;
12108
12109 default:
12110 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12111 break;
12112 }
12113
12114 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
12115 }
12116
12117 /* Assuming the inferior is stopped at an exception catchpoint,
12118 return the message which was associated to the exception, if
12119 available. Return NULL if the message could not be retrieved.
12120
12121 Note: The exception message can be associated to an exception
12122 either through the use of the Raise_Exception function, or
12123 more simply (Ada 2005 and later), via:
12124
12125 raise Exception_Name with "exception message";
12126
12127 */
12128
12129 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
12130 ada_exception_message_1 (void)
12131 {
12132 struct value *e_msg_val;
12133 int e_msg_len;
12134
12135 /* For runtimes that support this feature, the exception message
12136 is passed as an unbounded string argument called "message". */
12137 e_msg_val = parse_and_eval ("message");
12138 if (e_msg_val == NULL)
12139 return NULL; /* Exception message not supported. */
12140
12141 e_msg_val = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (e_msg_val);
12142 gdb_assert (e_msg_val != NULL);
12143 e_msg_len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (e_msg_val));
12144
12145 /* If the message string is empty, then treat it as if there was
12146 no exception message. */
12147 if (e_msg_len <= 0)
12148 return NULL;
12149
12150 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> e_msg ((char *) xmalloc (e_msg_len + 1));
12151 read_memory_string (value_address (e_msg_val), e_msg.get (), e_msg_len + 1);
12152 e_msg.get ()[e_msg_len] = '\0';
12153
12154 return e_msg;
12155 }
12156
12157 /* Same as ada_exception_message_1, except that all exceptions are
12158 contained here (returning NULL instead). */
12159
12160 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
12161 ada_exception_message (void)
12162 {
12163 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> e_msg;
12164
12165 try
12166 {
12167 e_msg = ada_exception_message_1 ();
12168 }
12169 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12170 {
12171 e_msg.reset (nullptr);
12172 }
12173
12174 return e_msg;
12175 }
12176
12177 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
12178 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
12179 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
12180 and zero is returned. */
12181
12182 static CORE_ADDR
12183 ada_exception_name_addr (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12184 struct breakpoint *b)
12185 {
12186 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
12187
12188 try
12189 {
12190 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
12191 }
12192
12193 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12194 {
12195 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.what ());
12196 return 0;
12197 }
12198
12199 return result;
12200 }
12201
12202 static std::string ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string
12203 (const char *excep_string,
12204 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex);
12205
12206 /* Ada catchpoints.
12207
12208 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will
12209 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user
12210 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this
12211 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse
12212 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations.
12213 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was
12214 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the
12215 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested
12216 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression
12217 when symbols change. */
12218
12219 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint
12220 breakpoint location. */
12221
12222 class ada_catchpoint_location : public bp_location
12223 {
12224 public:
12225 ada_catchpoint_location (breakpoint *owner)
12226 : bp_location (owner, bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
12227 {}
12228
12229 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised
12230 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint
12231 creation. */
12232 expression_up excep_cond_expr;
12233 };
12234
12235 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint. */
12236
12237 struct ada_catchpoint : public breakpoint
12238 {
12239 explicit ada_catchpoint (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind kind)
12240 : m_kind (kind)
12241 {
12242 }
12243
12244 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */
12245 std::string excep_string;
12246
12247 /* What kind of catchpoint this is. */
12248 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind m_kind;
12249 };
12250
12251 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the
12252 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */
12253
12254 static void
12255 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c,
12256 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12257 {
12258 struct bp_location *bl;
12259
12260 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */
12261 if (c->excep_string.empty ())
12262 return;
12263
12264 /* Same if there are no locations... */
12265 if (c->loc == NULL)
12266 return;
12267
12268 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific
12269 expection we want to catch. */
12270 std::string cond_string
12271 = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string.c_str (), ex);
12272
12273 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an
12274 expression for each. */
12275 for (bl = c->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
12276 {
12277 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12278 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12279 expression_up exp;
12280
12281 if (!bl->shlib_disabled)
12282 {
12283 const char *s;
12284
12285 s = cond_string.c_str ();
12286 try
12287 {
12288 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl->address,
12289 block_for_pc (bl->address),
12290 0);
12291 }
12292 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12293 {
12294 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition "
12295 "for catchpoint %d: %s"),
12296 c->number, e.what ());
12297 }
12298 }
12299
12300 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = std::move (exp);
12301 }
12302 }
12303
12304 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops
12305 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12306
12307 static struct bp_location *
12308 allocate_location_exception (struct breakpoint *self)
12309 {
12310 return new ada_catchpoint_location (self);
12311 }
12312
12313 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
12314 exception catchpoint kinds. */
12315
12316 static void
12317 re_set_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12318 {
12319 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12320
12321 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's
12322 locations. */
12323 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b);
12324
12325 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each
12326 location. */
12327 create_excep_cond_exprs (c, c->m_kind);
12328 }
12329
12330 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the
12331 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop
12332 if the program thrown that exception. */
12333
12334 static int
12335 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl)
12336 {
12337 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
12338 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12339 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12340 int stop;
12341
12342 struct internalvar *var = lookup_internalvar ("_ada_exception");
12343 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_assert)
12344 clear_internalvar (var);
12345 else
12346 {
12347 try
12348 {
12349 const char *expr;
12350
12351 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_handlers)
12352 expr = ("GNAT_GCC_exception_Access(gcc_exception)"
12353 ".all.occurrence.id");
12354 else
12355 expr = "e";
12356
12357 struct value *exc = parse_and_eval (expr);
12358 set_internalvar (var, exc);
12359 }
12360 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
12361 {
12362 clear_internalvar (var);
12363 }
12364 }
12365
12366 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */
12367 if (c->excep_string.empty ())
12368 return 1;
12369
12370 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL)
12371 {
12372 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating
12373 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */
12374 return 1;
12375 }
12376
12377 stop = 1;
12378 try
12379 {
12380 struct value *mark;
12381
12382 mark = value_mark ();
12383 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr.get ()));
12384 value_free_to_mark (mark);
12385 }
12386 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
12387 {
12388 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
12389 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n"));
12390 }
12391
12392 return stop;
12393 }
12394
12395 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12396 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12397
12398 static void
12399 check_status_exception (bpstat bs)
12400 {
12401 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at);
12402 }
12403
12404 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12405 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12406
12407 static enum print_stop_action
12408 print_it_exception (bpstat bs)
12409 {
12410 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12411 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12412
12413 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
12414
12415 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12416 {
12417 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12418 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12419 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12420 }
12421
12422 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del
12423 ? "\nTemporary catchpoint " : "\nCatchpoint ");
12424 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
12425 uiout->text (", ");
12426
12427 /* ada_exception_name_addr relies on the selected frame being the
12428 current frame. Need to do this here because this function may be
12429 called more than once when printing a stop, and below, we'll
12430 select the first frame past the Ada run-time (see
12431 ada_find_printable_frame). */
12432 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
12433
12434 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12435 switch (c->m_kind)
12436 {
12437 case ada_catch_exception:
12438 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12439 case ada_catch_handlers:
12440 {
12441 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (c->m_kind, b);
12442 char exception_name[256];
12443
12444 if (addr != 0)
12445 {
12446 read_memory (addr, (gdb_byte *) exception_name,
12447 sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
12448 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
12449 }
12450 else
12451 {
12452 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception
12453 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled
12454 without debugging info, for instance. In that case,
12455 just replace the exception name by the generic string
12456 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the
12457 notification we are about to print. */
12458 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception"));
12459 }
12460 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print
12461 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make
12462 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got
12463 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra
12464 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */
12465 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_exception_unhandled)
12466 uiout->text ("unhandled ");
12467 uiout->field_string ("exception-name", exception_name);
12468 }
12469 break;
12470 case ada_catch_assert:
12471 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really
12472 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer
12473 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint.
12474 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in
12475 the MI output. */
12476 uiout->text ("failed assertion");
12477 break;
12478 }
12479
12480 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> exception_message = ada_exception_message ();
12481 if (exception_message != NULL)
12482 {
12483 uiout->text (" (");
12484 uiout->field_string ("exception-message", exception_message.get ());
12485 uiout->text (")");
12486 }
12487
12488 uiout->text (" at ");
12489 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
12490
12491 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12492 }
12493
12494 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12495 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12496
12497 static void
12498 print_one_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
12499 {
12500 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12501 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12502 struct value_print_options opts;
12503
12504 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12505
12506 if (opts.addressprint)
12507 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
12508
12509 annotate_field (5);
12510 switch (c->m_kind)
12511 {
12512 case ada_catch_exception:
12513 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12514 {
12515 std::string msg = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception"),
12516 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12517
12518 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
12519 }
12520 else
12521 uiout->field_string ("what", "all Ada exceptions");
12522
12523 break;
12524
12525 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12526 uiout->field_string ("what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
12527 break;
12528
12529 case ada_catch_handlers:
12530 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12531 {
12532 uiout->field_fmt ("what",
12533 _("`%s' Ada exception handlers"),
12534 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12535 }
12536 else
12537 uiout->field_string ("what", "all Ada exceptions handlers");
12538 break;
12539
12540 case ada_catch_assert:
12541 uiout->field_string ("what", "failed Ada assertions");
12542 break;
12543
12544 default:
12545 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12546 break;
12547 }
12548 }
12549
12550 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12551 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12552
12553 static void
12554 print_mention_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12555 {
12556 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12557 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12558
12559 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
12560 : _("Catchpoint "));
12561 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
12562 uiout->text (": ");
12563
12564 switch (c->m_kind)
12565 {
12566 case ada_catch_exception:
12567 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12568 {
12569 std::string info = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception"),
12570 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12571 uiout->text (info.c_str ());
12572 }
12573 else
12574 uiout->text (_("all Ada exceptions"));
12575 break;
12576
12577 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12578 uiout->text (_("unhandled Ada exceptions"));
12579 break;
12580
12581 case ada_catch_handlers:
12582 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12583 {
12584 std::string info
12585 = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception handlers"),
12586 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12587 uiout->text (info.c_str ());
12588 }
12589 else
12590 uiout->text (_("all Ada exceptions handlers"));
12591 break;
12592
12593 case ada_catch_assert:
12594 uiout->text (_("failed Ada assertions"));
12595 break;
12596
12597 default:
12598 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12599 break;
12600 }
12601 }
12602
12603 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12604 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12605
12606 static void
12607 print_recreate_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12608 {
12609 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12610
12611 switch (c->m_kind)
12612 {
12613 case ada_catch_exception:
12614 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception");
12615 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12616 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string.c_str ());
12617 break;
12618
12619 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12620 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled");
12621 break;
12622
12623 case ada_catch_handlers:
12624 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch handlers");
12625 break;
12626
12627 case ada_catch_assert:
12628 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert");
12629 break;
12630
12631 default:
12632 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12633 }
12634 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
12635 }
12636
12637 /* Virtual tables for various breakpoint types. */
12638 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
12639 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
12640 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
12641 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops;
12642
12643 /* See ada-lang.h. */
12644
12645 bool
12646 is_ada_exception_catchpoint (breakpoint *bp)
12647 {
12648 return (bp->ops == &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops
12649 || bp->ops == &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops
12650 || bp->ops == &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops
12651 || bp->ops == &catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops);
12652 }
12653
12654 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
12655 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
12656 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
12657 specified by the user.
12658 IS_CATCH_HANDLERS_CMD: True if the arguments are for a
12659 "catch handlers" command. False otherwise.
12660 If a condition is found at the end of the arguments, the condition
12661 expression is stored in COND_STRING (memory must be deallocated
12662 after use). Otherwise COND_STRING is set to NULL. */
12663
12664 static void
12665 catch_ada_exception_command_split (const char *args,
12666 bool is_catch_handlers_cmd,
12667 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
12668 std::string *excep_string,
12669 std::string *cond_string)
12670 {
12671 std::string exception_name;
12672
12673 exception_name = extract_arg (&args);
12674 if (exception_name == "if")
12675 {
12676 /* This is not an exception name; this is the start of a condition
12677 expression for a catchpoint on all exceptions. So, "un-get"
12678 this token, and set exception_name to NULL. */
12679 exception_name.clear ();
12680 args -= 2;
12681 }
12682
12683 /* Check to see if we have a condition. */
12684
12685 args = skip_spaces (args);
12686 if (startswith (args, "if")
12687 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
12688 {
12689 args += 2;
12690 args = skip_spaces (args);
12691
12692 if (args[0] == '\0')
12693 error (_("Condition missing after `if' keyword"));
12694 *cond_string = args;
12695
12696 args += strlen (args);
12697 }
12698
12699 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
12700 is unexpected. */
12701
12702 if (args[0] != '\0')
12703 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
12704
12705 if (is_catch_handlers_cmd)
12706 {
12707 /* Catch handling of exceptions. */
12708 *ex = ada_catch_handlers;
12709 *excep_string = exception_name;
12710 }
12711 else if (exception_name.empty ())
12712 {
12713 /* Catch all exceptions. */
12714 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12715 excep_string->clear ();
12716 }
12717 else if (exception_name == "unhandled")
12718 {
12719 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
12720 *ex = ada_catch_exception_unhandled;
12721 excep_string->clear ();
12722 }
12723 else
12724 {
12725 /* Catch a specific exception. */
12726 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12727 *excep_string = exception_name;
12728 }
12729 }
12730
12731 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
12732 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
12733
12734 static const char *
12735 ada_exception_sym_name (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12736 {
12737 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12738
12739 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL);
12740
12741 switch (ex)
12742 {
12743 case ada_catch_exception:
12744 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
12745 break;
12746 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12747 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
12748 break;
12749 case ada_catch_assert:
12750 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
12751 break;
12752 case ada_catch_handlers:
12753 return (data->exception_info->catch_handlers_sym);
12754 break;
12755 default:
12756 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12757 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12758 }
12759 }
12760
12761 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
12762 of the EX kind. */
12763
12764 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
12765 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12766 {
12767 switch (ex)
12768 {
12769 case ada_catch_exception:
12770 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
12771 break;
12772 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12773 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
12774 break;
12775 case ada_catch_assert:
12776 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
12777 break;
12778 case ada_catch_handlers:
12779 return (&catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops);
12780 break;
12781 default:
12782 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12783 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12784 }
12785 }
12786
12787 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
12788 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
12789 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
12790 an exception catchpoint.
12791 EX: the type of catchpoints used for catching Ada exceptions. */
12792
12793 static std::string
12794 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string,
12795 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12796 {
12797 int i;
12798 bool is_standard_exc = false;
12799 std::string result;
12800
12801 if (ex == ada_catch_handlers)
12802 {
12803 /* For exception handlers catchpoints, the condition string does
12804 not use the same parameter as for the other exceptions. */
12805 result = ("long_integer (GNAT_GCC_exception_Access"
12806 "(gcc_exception).all.occurrence.id)");
12807 }
12808 else
12809 result = "long_integer (e)";
12810
12811 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
12812 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
12813 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
12814 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
12815 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
12816 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
12817 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
12818 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
12819
12820 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
12821 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
12822 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
12823 standard.constraint_error".
12824
12825 If an exception named constraint_error is defined in another package of
12826 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
12827 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
12828 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
12829
12830 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
12831 {
12832 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0)
12833 {
12834 is_standard_exc = true;
12835 break;
12836 }
12837 }
12838
12839 result += " = ";
12840
12841 if (is_standard_exc)
12842 string_appendf (result, "long_integer (&standard.%s)", excep_string);
12843 else
12844 string_appendf (result, "long_integer (&%s)", excep_string);
12845
12846 return result;
12847 }
12848
12849 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
12850 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
12851
12852 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real
12853 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the
12854 type of catchpoint we need to create. */
12855
12856 static struct symtab_and_line
12857 ada_exception_sal (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12858 std::string *addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
12859 {
12860 const char *sym_name;
12861 struct symbol *sym;
12862
12863 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
12864 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
12865
12866 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
12867 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
12868 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
12869 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
12870
12871 if (sym == NULL)
12872 error (_("Catchpoint symbol not found: %s"), sym_name);
12873
12874 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
12875 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. %s is not a function."), sym_name);
12876
12877 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
12878 *addr_string = sym_name;
12879
12880 /* Set OPS. */
12881 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
12882
12883 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
12884 }
12885
12886 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint.
12887
12888 EX_KIND is the kind of exception catchpoint to be created.
12889
12890 If EXCEPT_STRING is empty, this catchpoint is expected to trigger
12891 for all exceptions. Otherwise, EXCEPT_STRING indicates the name
12892 of the exception to which this catchpoint applies.
12893
12894 COND_STRING, if not empty, is the catchpoint condition.
12895
12896 TEMPFLAG, if nonzero, means that the underlying breakpoint
12897 should be temporary.
12898
12899 FROM_TTY is the usual argument passed to all commands implementations. */
12900
12901 void
12902 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12903 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind,
12904 const std::string &excep_string,
12905 const std::string &cond_string,
12906 int tempflag,
12907 int disabled,
12908 int from_tty)
12909 {
12910 std::string addr_string;
12911 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
12912 struct symtab_and_line sal = ada_exception_sal (ex_kind, &addr_string, &ops);
12913
12914 std::unique_ptr<ada_catchpoint> c (new ada_catchpoint (ex_kind));
12915 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, sal, addr_string.c_str (),
12916 ops, tempflag, disabled, from_tty);
12917 c->excep_string = excep_string;
12918 create_excep_cond_exprs (c.get (), ex_kind);
12919 if (!cond_string.empty ())
12920 set_breakpoint_condition (c.get (), cond_string.c_str (), from_tty);
12921 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
12922 }
12923
12924 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
12925
12926 static void
12927 catch_ada_exception_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
12928 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12929 {
12930 const char *arg = arg_entry;
12931 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12932 int tempflag;
12933 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12934 std::string excep_string;
12935 std::string cond_string;
12936
12937 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12938
12939 if (!arg)
12940 arg = "";
12941 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, false, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
12942 &cond_string);
12943 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
12944 excep_string, cond_string,
12945 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12946 from_tty);
12947 }
12948
12949 /* Implement the "catch handlers" command. */
12950
12951 static void
12952 catch_ada_handlers_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
12953 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12954 {
12955 const char *arg = arg_entry;
12956 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12957 int tempflag;
12958 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12959 std::string excep_string;
12960 std::string cond_string;
12961
12962 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12963
12964 if (!arg)
12965 arg = "";
12966 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, true, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
12967 &cond_string);
12968 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
12969 excep_string, cond_string,
12970 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12971 from_tty);
12972 }
12973
12974 /* Completion function for the Ada "catch" commands. */
12975
12976 static void
12977 catch_ada_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, completion_tracker &tracker,
12978 const char *text, const char *word)
12979 {
12980 std::vector<ada_exc_info> exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (NULL);
12981
12982 for (const ada_exc_info &info : exceptions)
12983 {
12984 if (startswith (info.name, word))
12985 tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (info.name));
12986 }
12987 }
12988
12989 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch assert" command.
12990
12991 ARGS contains the command's arguments (or the empty string if
12992 no arguments were passed).
12993
12994 If ARGS contains a condition, set COND_STRING to that condition
12995 (the memory needs to be deallocated after use). */
12996
12997 static void
12998 catch_ada_assert_command_split (const char *args, std::string &cond_string)
12999 {
13000 args = skip_spaces (args);
13001
13002 /* Check whether a condition was provided. */
13003 if (startswith (args, "if")
13004 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
13005 {
13006 args += 2;
13007 args = skip_spaces (args);
13008 if (args[0] == '\0')
13009 error (_("condition missing after `if' keyword"));
13010 cond_string.assign (args);
13011 }
13012
13013 /* Otherwise, there should be no other argument at the end of
13014 the command. */
13015 else if (args[0] != '\0')
13016 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
13017 }
13018
13019 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
13020
13021 static void
13022 catch_assert_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
13023 struct cmd_list_element *command)
13024 {
13025 const char *arg = arg_entry;
13026 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
13027 int tempflag;
13028 std::string cond_string;
13029
13030 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
13031
13032 if (!arg)
13033 arg = "";
13034 catch_ada_assert_command_split (arg, cond_string);
13035 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ada_catch_assert,
13036 "", cond_string,
13037 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
13038 from_tty);
13039 }
13040
13041 /* Return non-zero if the symbol SYM is an Ada exception object. */
13042
13043 static int
13044 ada_is_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
13045 {
13046 const char *type_name = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym)->name ();
13047
13048 return (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF
13049 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK
13050 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_CONST
13051 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED
13052 && type_name != NULL && strcmp (type_name, "exception") == 0);
13053 }
13054
13055 /* Given a global symbol SYM, return non-zero iff SYM is a non-standard
13056 Ada exception object. This matches all exceptions except the ones
13057 defined by the Ada language. */
13058
13059 static int
13060 ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
13061 {
13062 int i;
13063
13064 if (!ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
13065 return 0;
13066
13067 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
13068 if (strcmp (sym->linkage_name (), standard_exc[i]) == 0)
13069 return 0; /* A standard exception. */
13070
13071 /* Numeric_Error is also a standard exception, so exclude it.
13072 See the STANDARD_EXC description for more details as to why
13073 this exception is not listed in that array. */
13074 if (strcmp (sym->linkage_name (), "numeric_error") == 0)
13075 return 0;
13076
13077 return 1;
13078 }
13079
13080 /* A helper function for std::sort, comparing two struct ada_exc_info
13081 objects.
13082
13083 The comparison is determined first by exception name, and then
13084 by exception address. */
13085
13086 bool
13087 ada_exc_info::operator< (const ada_exc_info &other) const
13088 {
13089 int result;
13090
13091 result = strcmp (name, other.name);
13092 if (result < 0)
13093 return true;
13094 if (result == 0 && addr < other.addr)
13095 return true;
13096 return false;
13097 }
13098
13099 bool
13100 ada_exc_info::operator== (const ada_exc_info &other) const
13101 {
13102 return addr == other.addr && strcmp (name, other.name) == 0;
13103 }
13104
13105 /* Sort EXCEPTIONS using compare_ada_exception_info as the comparison
13106 routine, but keeping the first SKIP elements untouched.
13107
13108 All duplicates are also removed. */
13109
13110 static void
13111 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions,
13112 int skip)
13113 {
13114 std::sort (exceptions->begin () + skip, exceptions->end ());
13115 exceptions->erase (std::unique (exceptions->begin () + skip, exceptions->end ()),
13116 exceptions->end ());
13117 }
13118
13119 /* Add all exceptions defined by the Ada standard whose name match
13120 a regular expression.
13121
13122 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13123 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13124 filtering is performed.
13125
13126 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13127 gets pushed. */
13128
13129 static void
13130 ada_add_standard_exceptions (compiled_regex *preg,
13131 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13132 {
13133 int i;
13134
13135 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
13136 {
13137 if (preg == NULL
13138 || preg->exec (standard_exc[i], 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
13139 {
13140 struct bound_minimal_symbol msymbol
13141 = ada_lookup_simple_minsym (standard_exc[i]);
13142
13143 if (msymbol.minsym != NULL)
13144 {
13145 struct ada_exc_info info
13146 = {standard_exc[i], BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msymbol)};
13147
13148 exceptions->push_back (info);
13149 }
13150 }
13151 }
13152 }
13153
13154 /* Add all Ada exceptions defined locally and accessible from the given
13155 FRAME.
13156
13157 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13158 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13159 filtering is performed.
13160
13161 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13162 gets pushed. */
13163
13164 static void
13165 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (compiled_regex *preg,
13166 struct frame_info *frame,
13167 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13168 {
13169 const struct block *block = get_frame_block (frame, 0);
13170
13171 while (block != 0)
13172 {
13173 struct block_iterator iter;
13174 struct symbol *sym;
13175
13176 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
13177 {
13178 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
13179 {
13180 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
13181 case LOC_BLOCK:
13182 case LOC_CONST:
13183 break;
13184 default:
13185 if (ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
13186 {
13187 struct ada_exc_info info = {sym->print_name (),
13188 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13189
13190 exceptions->push_back (info);
13191 }
13192 }
13193 }
13194 if (BLOCK_FUNCTION (block) != NULL)
13195 break;
13196 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
13197 }
13198 }
13199
13200 /* Return true if NAME matches PREG or if PREG is NULL. */
13201
13202 static bool
13203 name_matches_regex (const char *name, compiled_regex *preg)
13204 {
13205 return (preg == NULL
13206 || preg->exec (ada_decode (name).c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0);
13207 }
13208
13209 /* Add all exceptions defined globally whose name name match
13210 a regular expression, excluding standard exceptions.
13211
13212 The reason we exclude standard exceptions is that they need
13213 to be handled separately: Standard exceptions are defined inside
13214 a runtime unit which is normally not compiled with debugging info,
13215 and thus usually do not show up in our symbol search. However,
13216 if the unit was in fact built with debugging info, we need to
13217 exclude them because they would duplicate the entry we found
13218 during the special loop that specifically searches for those
13219 standard exceptions.
13220
13221 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13222 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13223 filtering is performed.
13224
13225 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13226 gets pushed. */
13227
13228 static void
13229 ada_add_global_exceptions (compiled_regex *preg,
13230 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13231 {
13232 /* In Ada, the symbol "search name" is a linkage name, whereas the
13233 regular expression used to do the matching refers to the natural
13234 name. So match against the decoded name. */
13235 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL,
13236 lookup_name_info::match_any (),
13237 [&] (const char *search_name)
13238 {
13239 std::string decoded = ada_decode (search_name);
13240 return name_matches_regex (decoded.c_str (), preg);
13241 },
13242 NULL,
13243 VARIABLES_DOMAIN);
13244
13245 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
13246 {
13247 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
13248 {
13249 const struct blockvector *bv = COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s);
13250 int i;
13251
13252 for (i = GLOBAL_BLOCK; i <= STATIC_BLOCK; i++)
13253 {
13254 const struct block *b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, i);
13255 struct block_iterator iter;
13256 struct symbol *sym;
13257
13258 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
13259 if (ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (sym)
13260 && name_matches_regex (sym->natural_name (), preg))
13261 {
13262 struct ada_exc_info info
13263 = {sym->print_name (), SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13264
13265 exceptions->push_back (info);
13266 }
13267 }
13268 }
13269 }
13270 }
13271
13272 /* Implements ada_exceptions_list with the regular expression passed
13273 as a regex_t, rather than a string.
13274
13275 If not NULL, PREG is used to filter out exceptions whose names
13276 do not match. Otherwise, all exceptions are listed. */
13277
13278 static std::vector<ada_exc_info>
13279 ada_exceptions_list_1 (compiled_regex *preg)
13280 {
13281 std::vector<ada_exc_info> result;
13282 int prev_len;
13283
13284 /* First, list the known standard exceptions. These exceptions
13285 need to be handled separately, as they are usually defined in
13286 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info. */
13287
13288 ada_add_standard_exceptions (preg, &result);
13289
13290 /* Next, find all exceptions whose scope is local and accessible
13291 from the currently selected frame. */
13292
13293 if (has_stack_frames ())
13294 {
13295 prev_len = result.size ();
13296 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (preg, get_selected_frame (NULL),
13297 &result);
13298 if (result.size () > prev_len)
13299 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13300 }
13301
13302 /* Add all exceptions whose scope is global. */
13303
13304 prev_len = result.size ();
13305 ada_add_global_exceptions (preg, &result);
13306 if (result.size () > prev_len)
13307 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13308
13309 return result;
13310 }
13311
13312 /* Return a vector of ada_exc_info.
13313
13314 If REGEXP is NULL, all exceptions are included in the result.
13315 Otherwise, it should contain a valid regular expression,
13316 and only the exceptions whose names match that regular expression
13317 are included in the result.
13318
13319 The exceptions are sorted in the following order:
13320 - Standard exceptions (defined by the Ada language), in
13321 alphabetical order;
13322 - Exceptions only visible from the current frame, in
13323 alphabetical order;
13324 - Exceptions whose scope is global, in alphabetical order. */
13325
13326 std::vector<ada_exc_info>
13327 ada_exceptions_list (const char *regexp)
13328 {
13329 if (regexp == NULL)
13330 return ada_exceptions_list_1 (NULL);
13331
13332 compiled_regex reg (regexp, REG_NOSUB, _("invalid regular expression"));
13333 return ada_exceptions_list_1 (&reg);
13334 }
13335
13336 /* Implement the "info exceptions" command. */
13337
13338 static void
13339 info_exceptions_command (const char *regexp, int from_tty)
13340 {
13341 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
13342
13343 std::vector<ada_exc_info> exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (regexp);
13344
13345 if (regexp != NULL)
13346 printf_filtered
13347 (_("All Ada exceptions matching regular expression \"%s\":\n"), regexp);
13348 else
13349 printf_filtered (_("All defined Ada exceptions:\n"));
13350
13351 for (const ada_exc_info &info : exceptions)
13352 printf_filtered ("%s: %s\n", info.name, paddress (gdbarch, info.addr));
13353 }
13354
13355 /* Operators */
13356 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
13357 below. */
13358 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
13359
13360 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
13361 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
13362 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
13363 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
13364 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
13365 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
13366 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
13367 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
13368 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
13369 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
13370 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
13371 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
13372 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
13373 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
13374 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
13375 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13376 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
13377 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
13378 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13379 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
13380
13381 static void
13382 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp,
13383 int *argsp)
13384 {
13385 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
13386 {
13387 default:
13388 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
13389 break;
13390
13391 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13392 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13393 ADA_OPERATORS;
13394 #undef OP_DEFN
13395
13396 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13397 *oplenp = 3;
13398 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
13399 break;
13400
13401 case OP_CHOICES:
13402 *oplenp = 3;
13403 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
13404 break;
13405 }
13406 }
13407
13408 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */
13409
13410 static int
13411 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos,
13412 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data),
13413 void *data)
13414 {
13415 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts;
13416 struct type *type = NULL;
13417
13418 switch (elts[pos].opcode)
13419 {
13420 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13421 case UNOP_QUAL:
13422 type = elts[pos + 1].type;
13423 break;
13424
13425 default:
13426 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data);
13427 }
13428
13429 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */
13430
13431 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type)
13432 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data))
13433 return 1;
13434
13435 return 0;
13436 }
13437
13438 static const char *
13439 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
13440 {
13441 switch (opcode)
13442 {
13443 default:
13444 return op_name_standard (opcode);
13445
13446 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
13447 ADA_OPERATORS;
13448 #undef OP_DEFN
13449
13450 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13451 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
13452 case OP_CHOICES:
13453 return "OP_CHOICES";
13454 case OP_NAME:
13455 return "OP_NAME";
13456 }
13457 }
13458
13459 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
13460 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
13461 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
13462
13463 static void
13464 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
13465 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
13466 {
13467 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
13468 {
13469 default:
13470 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
13471 break;
13472
13473 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13474 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13475 ADA_OPERATORS;
13476 #undef OP_DEFN
13477
13478 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13479 *oplenp = 3;
13480 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13481 break;
13482
13483 case OP_CHOICES:
13484 *oplenp = 3;
13485 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
13486 break;
13487
13488 case OP_STRING:
13489 case OP_NAME:
13490 {
13491 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13492
13493 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
13494 *argsp = 0;
13495 break;
13496 }
13497 }
13498 }
13499
13500 static int
13501 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
13502 {
13503 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
13504 int oplen, nargs;
13505 int pc = elt;
13506 int i;
13507
13508 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
13509
13510 switch (op)
13511 {
13512 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
13513 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13514 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13515 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13516 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13517 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13518 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13519 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13520 case OP_ATR_POS:
13521 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13522 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13523 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13524 break;
13525
13526 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13527 case UNOP_QUAL:
13528 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
13529 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
13530 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
13531 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
13532 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
13533 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
13534 break;
13535 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13536 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
13537 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
13538 break;
13539 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13540 break;
13541
13542 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13543 case OP_OTHERS:
13544 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13545 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13546 case OP_CHOICES:
13547 break;
13548
13549 case OP_NAME:
13550 case OP_STRING:
13551 {
13552 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
13553 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
13554
13555 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
13556 break;
13557 }
13558
13559 default:
13560 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
13561 }
13562
13563 elt += oplen;
13564 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13565 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
13566
13567 return elt;
13568 }
13569
13570 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
13571
13572 static void
13573 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
13574 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
13575 {
13576 int oplen, nargs, i;
13577 int pc = *pos;
13578 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
13579
13580 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
13581
13582 *pos += oplen;
13583 switch (op)
13584 {
13585 default:
13586 *pos -= oplen;
13587 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
13588 return;
13589
13590 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
13591 fputs_filtered (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->natural_name (), stream);
13592 return;
13593
13594 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13595 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13596 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13597 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13598 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13599 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
13600 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
13601 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
13602 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13603 return;
13604
13605 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13606 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13607 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13608 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13609 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13610 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13611 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13612 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
13613 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13614 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13615 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13616 return;
13617
13618 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13619 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13620 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13621 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13622 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13623 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13624 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13625 case OP_ATR_POS:
13626 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13627 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13628 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13629 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
13630 {
13631 if (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type->code () != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
13632 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0,
13633 &type_print_raw_options);
13634 *pos += 3;
13635 }
13636 else
13637 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13638 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
13639 if (nargs > 1)
13640 {
13641 int tem;
13642
13643 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
13644 {
13645 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
13646 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
13647 }
13648 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13649 }
13650 return;
13651
13652 case UNOP_QUAL:
13653 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
13654 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
13655 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
13656 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13657 return;
13658
13659 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13660 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13661 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13662 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13663 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0,
13664 &type_print_raw_options);
13665 return;
13666
13667 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13668 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13669 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
13670 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13671 return;
13672
13673 case OP_OTHERS:
13674 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
13675 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13676 return;
13677
13678 case OP_CHOICES:
13679 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
13680 {
13681 if (i > 0)
13682 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
13683 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13684 }
13685 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
13686 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13687 return;
13688
13689 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13690 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13691 return;
13692
13693 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13694 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13695 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13696 {
13697 if (i > 0)
13698 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
13699 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13700 }
13701 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13702 return;
13703 }
13704 }
13705
13706 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
13707 and precedences of the operators. */
13708
13709 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
13710 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
13711 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
13712 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
13713 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
13714 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
13715 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
13716 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13717 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13718 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13719 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13720 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13721 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13722 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13723 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13724 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
13725 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
13726 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
13727 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
13728 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
13729 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
13730 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
13731 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13732 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13733 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13734 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13735 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13736 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13737 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13738 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13739 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13740 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13741 {NULL, OP_NULL, PREC_SUFFIX, 0}
13742 };
13743 \f
13744 enum ada_primitive_types {
13745 ada_primitive_type_int,
13746 ada_primitive_type_long,
13747 ada_primitive_type_short,
13748 ada_primitive_type_char,
13749 ada_primitive_type_float,
13750 ada_primitive_type_double,
13751 ada_primitive_type_void,
13752 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
13753 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
13754 ada_primitive_type_natural,
13755 ada_primitive_type_positive,
13756 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
13757 ada_primitive_type_storage_offset,
13758 nr_ada_primitive_types
13759 };
13760
13761 \f
13762 /* Language vector */
13763
13764 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
13765
13766 static void
13767 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
13768 {
13769 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
13770 }
13771
13772 static int
13773 parse (struct parser_state *ps)
13774 {
13775 warnings_issued = 0;
13776 return ada_parse (ps);
13777 }
13778
13779 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
13780 ada_print_subexp,
13781 ada_operator_length,
13782 ada_operator_check,
13783 ada_op_name,
13784 ada_dump_subexp_body,
13785 ada_evaluate_subexp
13786 };
13787
13788 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype adapter for wild_match. */
13789
13790 static bool
13791 do_wild_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13792 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13793 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13794 {
13795 return wild_match (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name));
13796 }
13797
13798 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype adapter for full_match. */
13799
13800 static bool
13801 do_full_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13802 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13803 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13804 {
13805 return full_match (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name));
13806 }
13807
13808 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype for exact (verbatim) matches. */
13809
13810 static bool
13811 do_exact_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13812 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13813 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13814 {
13815 return strcmp (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name)) == 0;
13816 }
13817
13818 /* Build the Ada lookup name for LOOKUP_NAME. */
13819
13820 ada_lookup_name_info::ada_lookup_name_info (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
13821 {
13822 gdb::string_view user_name = lookup_name.name ();
13823
13824 if (user_name[0] == '<')
13825 {
13826 if (user_name.back () == '>')
13827 m_encoded_name
13828 = user_name.substr (1, user_name.size () - 2).to_string ();
13829 else
13830 m_encoded_name
13831 = user_name.substr (1, user_name.size () - 1).to_string ();
13832 m_encoded_p = true;
13833 m_verbatim_p = true;
13834 m_wild_match_p = false;
13835 m_standard_p = false;
13836 }
13837 else
13838 {
13839 m_verbatim_p = false;
13840
13841 m_encoded_p = user_name.find ("__") != gdb::string_view::npos;
13842
13843 if (!m_encoded_p)
13844 {
13845 const char *folded = ada_fold_name (user_name);
13846 const char *encoded = ada_encode_1 (folded, false);
13847 if (encoded != NULL)
13848 m_encoded_name = encoded;
13849 else
13850 m_encoded_name = user_name.to_string ();
13851 }
13852 else
13853 m_encoded_name = user_name.to_string ();
13854
13855 /* Handle the 'package Standard' special case. See description
13856 of m_standard_p. */
13857 if (startswith (m_encoded_name.c_str (), "standard__"))
13858 {
13859 m_encoded_name = m_encoded_name.substr (sizeof ("standard__") - 1);
13860 m_standard_p = true;
13861 }
13862 else
13863 m_standard_p = false;
13864
13865 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
13866 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
13867 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks
13868 like an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild
13869 mode. Also, in the standard__ special case always do
13870 non-wild matching. */
13871 m_wild_match_p
13872 = (lookup_name.match_type () != symbol_name_match_type::FULL
13873 && !m_encoded_p
13874 && !m_standard_p
13875 && user_name.find ('.') == std::string::npos);
13876 }
13877 }
13878
13879 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype method for Ada. This only handles
13880 completion mode. */
13881
13882 static bool
13883 ada_symbol_name_matches (const char *symbol_search_name,
13884 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13885 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13886 {
13887 return lookup_name.ada ().matches (symbol_search_name,
13888 lookup_name.match_type (),
13889 comp_match_res);
13890 }
13891
13892 /* A name matcher that matches the symbol name exactly, with
13893 strcmp. */
13894
13895 static bool
13896 literal_symbol_name_matcher (const char *symbol_search_name,
13897 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13898 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13899 {
13900 gdb::string_view name_view = lookup_name.name ();
13901
13902 if (lookup_name.completion_mode ()
13903 ? (strncmp (symbol_search_name, name_view.data (),
13904 name_view.size ()) == 0)
13905 : symbol_search_name == name_view)
13906 {
13907 if (comp_match_res != NULL)
13908 comp_match_res->set_match (symbol_search_name);
13909 return true;
13910 }
13911 else
13912 return false;
13913 }
13914
13915 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_matcher" language_defn method for
13916 Ada. */
13917
13918 static symbol_name_matcher_ftype *
13919 ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
13920 {
13921 if (lookup_name.match_type () == symbol_name_match_type::SEARCH_NAME)
13922 return literal_symbol_name_matcher;
13923
13924 if (lookup_name.completion_mode ())
13925 return ada_symbol_name_matches;
13926 else
13927 {
13928 if (lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ())
13929 return do_wild_match;
13930 else if (lookup_name.ada ().verbatim_p ())
13931 return do_exact_match;
13932 else
13933 return do_full_match;
13934 }
13935 }
13936
13937 static const char *ada_extensions[] =
13938 {
13939 ".adb", ".ads", ".a", ".ada", ".dg", NULL
13940 };
13941
13942 /* Constant data that describes the Ada language. */
13943
13944 extern const struct language_data ada_language_data =
13945 {
13946 "ada", /* Language name */
13947 "Ada",
13948 language_ada,
13949 range_check_off,
13950 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
13951 that's not quite what this means. */
13952 array_row_major,
13953 macro_expansion_no,
13954 ada_extensions,
13955 &ada_exp_descriptor,
13956 parse,
13957 resolve,
13958 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
13959 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
13960 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
13961 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
13962 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
13963 ada_value_print_inner, /* la_value_print_inner */
13964 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
13965 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
13966 NULL, /* name_of_this */
13967 true, /* la_store_sym_names_in_linkage_form_p */
13968 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
13969 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
13970 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name,
13971 NULL, /* Language specific
13972 class_name_from_physname */
13973 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
13974 0, /* c-style arrays */
13975 1, /* String lower bound */
13976 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
13977 ada_collect_symbol_completion_matches,
13978 ada_watch_location_expression,
13979 ada_get_symbol_name_matcher, /* la_get_symbol_name_matcher */
13980 &ada_varobj_ops,
13981 NULL,
13982 ada_is_string_type,
13983 "(...)" /* la_struct_too_deep_ellipsis */
13984 };
13985
13986 /* Class representing the Ada language. */
13987
13988 class ada_language : public language_defn
13989 {
13990 public:
13991 ada_language ()
13992 : language_defn (language_ada, ada_language_data)
13993 { /* Nothing. */ }
13994
13995 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
13996
13997 void print_array_index (struct type *index_type,
13998 LONGEST index,
13999 struct ui_file *stream,
14000 const value_print_options *options) const override
14001 {
14002 struct value *index_value = val_atr (index_type, index);
14003
14004 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
14005 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
14006 }
14007
14008 /* Implement the "read_var_value" language_defn method for Ada. */
14009
14010 struct value *read_var_value (struct symbol *var,
14011 const struct block *var_block,
14012 struct frame_info *frame) const override
14013 {
14014 /* The only case where default_read_var_value is not sufficient
14015 is when VAR is a renaming... */
14016 if (frame != nullptr)
14017 {
14018 const struct block *frame_block = get_frame_block (frame, NULL);
14019 if (frame_block != nullptr && ada_is_renaming_symbol (var))
14020 return ada_read_renaming_var_value (var, frame_block);
14021 }
14022
14023 /* This is a typical case where we expect the default_read_var_value
14024 function to work. */
14025 return language_defn::read_var_value (var, var_block, frame);
14026 }
14027
14028 /* See language.h. */
14029 void language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14030 struct language_arch_info *lai) const override
14031 {
14032 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
14033
14034 lai->primitive_type_vector
14035 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
14036 struct type *);
14037
14038 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
14039 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
14040 0, "integer");
14041 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
14042 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
14043 0, "long_integer");
14044 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
14045 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
14046 0, "short_integer");
14047 lai->string_char_type
14048 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
14049 = arch_character_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
14050 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
14051 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
14052 "float", gdbarch_float_format (gdbarch));
14053 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
14054 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
14055 "long_float", gdbarch_double_format (gdbarch));
14056 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
14057 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
14058 0, "long_long_integer");
14059 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
14060 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_double_bit (gdbarch),
14061 "long_long_float", gdbarch_long_double_format (gdbarch));
14062 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
14063 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
14064 0, "natural");
14065 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
14066 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
14067 0, "positive");
14068 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
14069 = builtin->builtin_void;
14070
14071 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
14072 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
14073 "void"));
14074 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
14075 ->set_name ("system__address");
14076
14077 /* Create the equivalent of the System.Storage_Elements.Storage_Offset
14078 type. This is a signed integral type whose size is the same as
14079 the size of addresses. */
14080 {
14081 unsigned int addr_length = TYPE_LENGTH
14082 (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]);
14083
14084 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_storage_offset]
14085 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, addr_length * HOST_CHAR_BIT, 0,
14086 "storage_offset");
14087 }
14088
14089 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
14090 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
14091 }
14092
14093 /* See language.h. */
14094
14095 bool iterate_over_symbols
14096 (const struct block *block, const lookup_name_info &name,
14097 domain_enum domain,
14098 gdb::function_view<symbol_found_callback_ftype> callback) const override
14099 {
14100 std::vector<struct block_symbol> results;
14101
14102 ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name, block, domain, &results, 0);
14103 for (block_symbol &sym : results)
14104 {
14105 if (!callback (&sym))
14106 return false;
14107 }
14108
14109 return true;
14110 }
14111 };
14112
14113 /* Single instance of the Ada language class. */
14114
14115 static ada_language ada_language_defn;
14116
14117 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */
14118 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list;
14119 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list;
14120
14121 static void
14122 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void)
14123 {
14124 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14125
14126 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
14127
14128 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
14129 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14130 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14131 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14132 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14133 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14134 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14135 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14136 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14137
14138 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
14139 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14140 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14141 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14142 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14143 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14144 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14145 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14146 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14147
14148 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
14149 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14150 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14151 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14152 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14153 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14154 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14155 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14156 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14157
14158 ops = &catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops;
14159 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14160 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14161 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14162 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14163 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14164 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14165 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14166 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14167 }
14168
14169 /* This module's 'new_objfile' observer. */
14170
14171 static void
14172 ada_new_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
14173 {
14174 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
14175 }
14176
14177 /* This module's 'free_objfile' observer. */
14178
14179 static void
14180 ada_free_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
14181 {
14182 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
14183 }
14184
14185 void _initialize_ada_language ();
14186 void
14187 _initialize_ada_language ()
14188 {
14189 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops ();
14190
14191 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class,
14192 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specific settings."),
14193 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist);
14194
14195 add_show_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class,
14196 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."),
14197 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist);
14198
14199 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure,
14200 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\
14201 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types."), _("\
14202 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated."),
14203 _("\
14204 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\
14205 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\
14206 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\
14207 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\
14208 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\
14209 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\
14210 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."),
14211 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
14212
14213 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("print-signatures", class_vars,
14214 &print_signatures, _("\
14215 Enable or disable the output of formal and return types for functions in the \
14216 overloads selection menu."), _("\
14217 Show whether the output of formal and return types for functions in the \
14218 overloads selection menu is activated."),
14219 NULL, NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
14220
14221 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
14222 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
14223 Usage: catch exception [ARG] [if CONDITION]\n\
14224 Without any argument, stop when any Ada exception is raised.\n\
14225 If ARG is \"unhandled\" (without the quotes), only stop when the exception\n\
14226 being raised does not have a handler (and will therefore lead to the task's\n\
14227 termination).\n\
14228 Otherwise, the catchpoint only stops when the name of the exception being\n\
14229 raised is the same as ARG.\n\
14230 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14231 exception should cause a stop."),
14232 catch_ada_exception_command,
14233 catch_ada_completer,
14234 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14235 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14236
14237 add_catch_command ("handlers", _("\
14238 Catch Ada exceptions, when handled.\n\
14239 Usage: catch handlers [ARG] [if CONDITION]\n\
14240 Without any argument, stop when any Ada exception is handled.\n\
14241 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name.\n\
14242 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14243 exception should cause a stop."),
14244 catch_ada_handlers_command,
14245 catch_ada_completer,
14246 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14247 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14248 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
14249 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
14250 Usage: catch assert [if CONDITION]\n\
14251 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14252 exception should cause a stop."),
14253 catch_assert_command,
14254 NULL,
14255 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14256 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14257
14258 varsize_limit = 65536;
14259 add_setshow_uinteger_cmd ("varsize-limit", class_support,
14260 &varsize_limit, _("\
14261 Set the maximum number of bytes allowed in a variable-size object."), _("\
14262 Show the maximum number of bytes allowed in a variable-size object."), _("\
14263 Attempts to access an object whose size is not a compile-time constant\n\
14264 and exceeds this limit will cause an error."),
14265 NULL, NULL, &setlist, &showlist);
14266
14267 add_info ("exceptions", info_exceptions_command,
14268 _("\
14269 List all Ada exception names.\n\
14270 Usage: info exceptions [REGEXP]\n\
14271 If a regular expression is passed as an argument, only those matching\n\
14272 the regular expression are listed."));
14273
14274 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance,
14275 _("Set Ada maintenance-related variables."),
14276 &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ",
14277 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_set_cmdlist);
14278
14279 add_show_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance,
14280 _("Show Ada maintenance-related variables."),
14281 &maint_show_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance show ada ",
14282 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_show_cmdlist);
14283
14284 add_setshow_boolean_cmd
14285 ("ignore-descriptive-types", class_maintenance,
14286 &ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p,
14287 _("Set whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
14288 _("Show whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
14289 _("\
14290 When enabled, the debugger will stop using the DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type\n\
14291 DWARF attribute."),
14292 NULL, NULL, &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, &maint_show_ada_cmdlist);
14293
14294 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc (256, htab_hash_string, streq_hash,
14295 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
14296
14297 /* The ada-lang observers. */
14298 gdb::observers::new_objfile.attach (ada_new_objfile_observer);
14299 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (ada_free_objfile_observer);
14300 gdb::observers::inferior_exit.attach (ada_inferior_exit);
14301 }